MAIL(1) | General Commands Manual | MAIL(1) |
NAME
Mail [v14.9.24]
—
send and receive Internet mail
SYNOPSIS
mail |
[-DdEFinv~# ]
[-: spec]
[-A account]
[:-a attachment:]
[:-b bcc-addr:]
[:-C "field: body":]
[:-c cc-addr:]
[-M type | -m file | -q file | -t ]
[-r from-addr]
[:-S var[=value]:]
[-s subject]
[:-T "field: addr":]
[:-X cmd:]
[:-Y cmd:]
[-. ] :to-addr:
[-- :mta-option:] |
mail |
[-DdEeHiNnRv~# ]
[-: spec]
[-A account]
[:-C "field: body":]
[-L spec]
[-r from-addr]
[:-S var[=value]:]
[-u user]
[:-X cmd:]
[:-Y cmd:]
[-- :mta-option:] |
mail |
[-DdEeHiNnRv~# ]
[-: spec]
[-A account]
[:-C "field: body":] -f
[-L spec]
[-r from-addr]
[:-S var[=value]:]
[:-X cmd:]
[:-Y cmd:]
[file]
[-- :mta-option:] |
mail |
-h | --help |
mail |
-V | --version |
DESCRIPTION
wysh
(Command modifiers). Behaviour is
flagged [v15-compat] and [no v15-compat], set
ting
v15-compat
(INTERNAL VARIABLES) will choose
new behaviour when applicable; giving it a value makes
wysh
an implied default. [Obsolete] flags what will
vanish.
Warning! v15-compat (with value) will be a default in v14.10.0!
Mail provides a simple and friendly environment for sending and receiving mail. It is intended to provide the functionality of the POSIX mailx(1) command, but is MIME capable and optionally offers extensions for line editing, S/MIME, SMTP and POP3, among others. Mail divides incoming mail into its constituent messages and allows the user to deal with them in any order. It offers many COMMANDS and INTERNAL VARIABLES for manipulating messages and sending mail. It provides the user simple editing capabilities to ease the composition of outgoing messages, and increasingly powerful and reliable non-interactive scripting capabilities.
Options
-:
spec,--resource-files
=..- Controls loading of (as via
source
) Resource files: spec is parsed case-insensitively, the letter ‘s
’ corresponds to the system wide mail.rc, ‘u
’ the user's personal file ~/.mailrc. The (original) system wide resource is also compiled-in, accessible via ‘x
’. The letters ‘-
’ and ‘/
’ disable usage of resource files. Order matters, default is ‘su
’. This option overrides-n
. -A
name,--account
=..- Activate user
account
name after program startup is complete (resource files loaded, only-X
commands are to be executed), and switch to its primary system mailbox (most likely the inbox). If activation fails the program exit
s if used non-interactively, or if any of errexit or posix are set. -a
file[=input-charset[#output-charset]],--attach
=..- (Send mode) Attach file. For (Compose mode)
opportunities refer to
~@
and~^
. file is subject to tilde expansion (see Filename transformations andfolder
); if it is not accessible but contains a ‘=
’ character, anything before the last ‘=
’ will be used as the filename, anything thereafter as a character set specification, as shown.If only an input character set is specified, the input side is fixed, and no character set conversion will be applied; an empty or the special string hyphen-minus ‘
-
’ is taken for ttycharset (the default). If an output character set has also been specified the desired conversion is performed immediately, not considering file type and content, except for an empty string or hyphen-minus ‘-
’, which select the default conversion algorithm (see Character sets): no immediate conversion is performed, file and its contents will be MIME-classified (HTML mail and MIME attachments, The mime.types files) first — only the latter mode is available unless features includes ‘,+iconv,
’. -B
- ([Obsolete]: Mail will always use line-buffered output, to gain
line-buffered input even in batch mode enable batch mode via
-#
.) -b
addr,--bcc
=..- (Send mode) Send a blind carbon copy to recipient addr. The option may be used multiple times. Also see the section On sending mail, and non-interactive mode.
-C
"field: body",--custom-header
=..- Create a custom header which persists for an entire session. A custom
header consists of the field name followed by a colon
‘
:
’ and the field content body, for example ‘-C "Blah: Neminem laede; imo omnes, quantum potes, juva"
’. Standard header field names cannot be overwritten by custom headers. Runtime adjustable custom headers are available via the variable customhdr, and in (Compose mode)~^
, one of the COMMAND ESCAPES, as well asdigmsg
are the most flexible and powerful options to manage message headers. This option may be used multiple times. -c
addr,--cc
=..- (Send mode) Just like
-b
, except it places the argument in the list of carbon copies. -D
,--disconnected
- [Option] Startup with disconnected
set
. -d
,--debug
- Enter a debug-only sandbox mode by setting the internal variable
debug; the same can be achieved via
‘
’ or ‘-S
debug
’. Also seeset
debug-v
. -E
,--discard-empty-messages
- (Send mode)
set
skipemptybody and thus discard messages with an empty message part body, successfully. -e
,--check-and-exit
- Just check if mail is present (in the system inbox
or the one specified via
-f
): if yes, return an exit status of zero, a non-zero value otherwise. To restrict the set of mails to consider in this evaluation a message specification can be added with the option-L
. Quickrun: does not open an interactive session. -F
- (Send mode) Save the message to send in a file named after the local part of the first recipient's address (instead of in record).
-f
,--file
- Read in the contents of the user's
secondary mailbox
MBOX
(or the specified file) for processing; when Mail is quit, it writes undeleted messages back to this file (but be aware of the hold option). The optional file argument will undergo some special Filename transformations (as viafolder
). Note that file is not an argument to the flag-f
, but is instead taken from the command line after option processing has been completed. In order to use a file that starts with a hyphen-minus, prefix with a relative path, as in ‘./-hyphenbox.mbox
’. -H
,--header-summary
- Display a summary of
headers
for the givenfolder
(depending on-u
, inbox orMAIL
, or as specified via-f
), then exit. A configurable summary view is available via the option-L
. This mode does not honour showlast. Quickrun: does not open an interactive session. -h
,--help
- Show a brief usage summary; use
--long-help
for a list long options. -i
set
ignore to ignore tty interrupt signals.-L
spec,--search
=..- Display a summary of
headers
of all messages that match the given spec in thefolder
found by the same algorithm used by-H
, then exit. See the section Specifying messages for the format of spec. This mode does not honour showlast.If the
-e
option has been given in addition no header summary is produced, but Mail will instead indicate via its exit status whether spec matched any messages (‘0
’) or not (‘1
’); note that any verbose output is suppressed in this mode and must instead be enabled explicitly (see-v
). Quickrun: does not open an interactive session. -M
type- (Send mode) Will flag standard input with the MIME
‘
Content-Type:
’ set to the given known type (HTML mail and MIME attachments, The mime.types files) and use it as the main message body. [v15 behaviour may differ] Using this option will bypass processing of message-inject-head and message-inject-tail. Also see-q
,-m
,-t
. -m
file- (Send mode) MIME classify the specified file and use
it as the main message body. [v15 behaviour may differ] Using this option
will bypass processing of message-inject-head and
message-inject-tail. Also see
-q
,-M
,-t
. -N
,--no-header-summary
- inhibit the initial display of message headers when reading mail or
editing a mailbox
folder
by callingunset
for the internal variable header. -n
- Standard flag that inhibits reading the system wide
mail.rc upon startup. The option
-:
allows more control over the startup sequence; also see Resource files. -q
file,--quote-file
=..- (Send mode) Initialize the message body with the contents of
file, which may be standard input
‘
-
’ only in non-interactive context. Also see-M
,-m
,-t
. -R
,--read-only
- Any mailbox
folder
akafolder
opened will be in read-only mode. -r
from-addr,--from-address
=..- The RFC 5321 reverse-path used for relaying and delegating messages to its
destination(s), for example to report delivery errors, is normally derived
from the address which appears in the from header
(or, if that contains multiple addresses, in
sender). A file-based aka local executable
mta (Mail-Transfer-Agent), however, instead uses the
local identity of the initiating user.
When this command line option is used the given single addressee from-addr will be assigned to the internal variable from, but in addition the command line option
-f
from-addr will be passed to a file-based mta whenever a message is sent. Shall from-addr include a user name the address components will be separated and the name part will be passed to a file-based mta individually via-F
name. Even though not a recipient the ‘shquote
’ expandaddr flag is supported.If an empty string is passed as from-addr then the content of the variable from (or, if that contains multiple addresses, sender) will be evaluated and used for this purpose whenever the file-based mta is contacted. By default, without
-r
that is, neither-f
nor-F
command line options are used when contacting a file-based MTA, unless this automatic deduction is enforced byset
ting the internal variable r-option-implicit.Remarks: many default installations and sites disallow overriding the local user identity like this unless either the MTA has been configured accordingly or the user is member of a group with special privileges. Passing an invalid address will cause an error.
-S
var[=value],--set
=..set
(or, with a prefix string ‘no
’, as documented in INTERNAL VARIABLES,unset
) variable and optionally assign value, if supported; [v15 behaviour may differ] the entire expression is evaluated as if specified within dollar-single-quotes (see Shell-style argument quoting) if the internal variable v15-compat is set. If the operation fails the program will exit if any of errexit or posix are set. Settings established via-S
cannot be changed from within Resource files or an account switch initiated by-A
. They will become mutable again before commands registered via-X
are executed.-s
subject,--subject
=..- (Send mode) Specify the subject of the message to be sent. Newline (NL) and carriage-return (CR) bytes are invalid and will be normalized to space (SP) characters.
-T
"field: addr",--target
=..- (Send mode) Add addr to the list of receivers
targeted by field, for now supported are only
‘
bcc
’, ‘cc
’, ‘fcc
’, and ‘to
’. Field and body (address) are separated by a colon ‘:
’ and optionally blank (space, tabulator) characters. The ‘shquote
’ expandaddr flag is supported. addr is parsed like a message header address line, as if it would be part of a template message fed in via-t
, and the same modifier suffix is supported. This option may be used multiple times. -t
,--template
- (Send mode) The text message given (on standard input) is expected to
contain, separated from the message body by an empty line, one or multiple
plain text message headers. [v15 behaviour may differ] Readily prepared
MIME mail messages cannot be passed. Headers can span multiple consecutive
lines if follow lines start with any amount of whitespace. A line starting
with the number sign ‘
#
’ in the first column is ignored. Message recipients can be given via the message headers ‘To:
’, ‘Cc:
’, ‘Bcc:
’ (the ‘?single
’ modifier enforces treatment as a single addressee, for example ‘To?single: exa, <m@ple>
’) or ‘Fcc:
’, they will be added to any recipients specified on the command line, and are likewise subject to expandaddr validity checks. If a message subject is specified via ‘Subject:
’ then it will be used in favour of one given on the command line.More optional headers are ‘
Reply-To:
’ (possibly overriding reply-to), ‘Sender:
’ (sender), ‘From:
’ (from and / or option-r
). ‘Message-ID:
’, ‘In-Reply-To:
’, ‘References:
’ and ‘Mail-Followup-To:
’, by default created automatically dependent on message context, will be used if specified (a special address massage will however still occur for the latter). Any other custom header field (also see-C
, customhdr and~^
) is passed through entirely unchanged, and in conjunction with the options-~
or-#
it is possible to embed COMMAND ESCAPES. Also see-M
,-m
,-q
. -u
user,--inbox-of
=..- Initially read the primary
system mailbox of user, appropriate privileges
presumed; effectively identical to
‘
’.-f
%user -V
,--version
- Show Mails version and exit. The command
version
will also show the list of features: ‘$ mail -:/ -Xversion -Xx
’. -v
,--verbose
set
s the internal variable verbose to enable logging of informational context messages. (Increases level of verbosity when used multiple times.) Also see-d
.-X
cmd,--startup-cmd
=..- Add the given (or multiple for a multiline argument)
cmd to a list of commands to be executed before
normal operation starts. The commands will be evaluated as a unit, just as
via
source
. Correlates with-#
and errexit. -Y
cmd,--cmd
=..- Add the given (or multiple for a multiline argument) cmd to a list of commands to be executed after normal operation has started. The commands will be evaluated successively in the given order, and as if given on the program's standard input — before interactive prompting begins in interactive mode, after standard input has been consumed otherwise.
-~
,--enable-cmd-escapes
- Enable COMMAND ESCAPES in
(Compose mode) even in non-interactive use cases. This can for example be
used to automatically format the composed message text before sending the
message:
$ ( echo 'line one. Word. Word2.';\ echo '~| /usr/bin/fmt -tuw66' ) |\ LC_ALL=C mail -d~:/ -Sttycharset=utf-8 bob@exam.ple
-#
,--batch-mode
- Enables batch mode: standard input is made line buffered, the complete set
of (interactive) commands is available, processing of
COMMAND ESCAPES is enabled in
Compose mode, and diverse
INTERNAL VARIABLES are
adjusted for batch necessities, exactly as if done via
-S
: emptystart, noerrexit, noheader, noposix, quiet, sendwait, typescript-mode as well asMAIL
,MBOX
and inbox (the latter three to /dev/null). Also, the values ofCOLUMNS
andLINES
are looked up, and acted upon. The following prepares an email message in a batched dry run:$ for name in bob alice@exam.ple lisa@exam.ple; do printf 'mail %s\n~s ubject\nText\n~.\n' "${name}" done | LC_ALL=C mail -#:x -Smta=test \ -X'alias bob bob@exam.ple'
-.
,--end-options
- This flag forces termination of option processing in order to prevent “option injection” (attacks). It also forcefully puts Mail into send mode, see On sending mail, and non-interactive mode.
If the setting of expandargv allows their
recognition all mta-option arguments given at the end
of the command line after a ‘--
’
separator will be passed through to a file-based mta
(Mail-Transfer-Agent) and persist for the entire session.
expandargv constraints do not apply to the content of
mta-arguments. Command line receiver address handling
supports the ‘shquote
’ constraint of
expandaddr, for more please see
On sending
mail, and non-interactive mode.
$ mail -#:/ -X 'addrcodec enc Hey, ho <silver@go>' -Xx
A starter
Mail is a direct descendant of BSD Mail, itself a successor to the Research UNIX mail which “was there from the start” according to HISTORY. It thus represents the user side of the UNIX mail system, whereas the system side (Mail-Transfer-Agent, MTA) was traditionally taken by sendmail(8) (and most MTAs provide a binary of this name for compatibility reasons). If the [Option]al SMTP mta is included in the features of Mail then the system side is not a mandatory precondition for mail delivery.
Mail strives for compliance with the POSIX
mailx(1) standard, but
posix, one of the
INTERNAL VARIABLES, or its
ENVIRONMENTal equivalent
POSIXLY_CORRECT
, needs to be set to adjust behaviour
to be almost on par. Almost, because there is one important difference:
POSIX Shell-style
argument quoting is ([v15 behaviour may differ] increasingly) used
instead of the Old-style
argument quoting that the standard documents, which is believed to be a
feature. The builtin as well as the (default) global
mail.rc
Resource files already bend the
standard imposed settings a bit.
For example, hold and
keepsave are set
in order to
suppress the automatic moving of messages to the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
that would otherwise occur (see
Message states), and
keep to not remove empty system MBOX mailbox files (or
all empty such files in posix mode) to avoid mangling
of file permissions when files eventually get recreated.
To enter interactive mode even if the initial mailbox is empty
emptystart is set, editheaders
to allow editing of headers as well as fullnames to
not strip down addresses in Compose
mode, and quote to include the message that is
being responded to when reply
ing, which is indented
by an indentprefix that also deviates from standard
imposed settings. mime-counter-evidence is fully
enabled, too. It sets followup-to-honour and
reply-to-honour to comply with reply address
desires.
Credentials and other settings are easily addressable by grouping
them via account
. The file mode creation mask can be
managed with umask. Files and shell pipe output can be
source
d for eval
uation, also
during startup from within the Resource
files. Informational context can be available by
set
ting verbose or
debug (as via -v
,
-d
).
On sending mail, and non-interactive mode
To send a message to one or more people, using a local or built-in
mta (Mail-Transfer-Agent) transport to actually
deliver the generated mail message, Mail can be invoked with arguments which
are the names of people to whom the mail will be sent, and the command line
options -b
and -c
can be
used to add (blind) carbon copy receivers:
# Via test MTA $ echo Hello, world | mail -:/ -Smta=test -s test $LOGNAME # Via sendmail(1) MTA $ </dev/null mail -:x -s test $LOGNAME # Debug dry-run mode: $ </dev/null LC_ALL=C mail -d -:/ \ -Sttycharset=utf8 -Sfullnames \ -b bcc@exam.ple -c cc@exam.ple -. \ '(Lovely) Bob <bob@exam.ple>' eric@exam.ple # With SMTP (no real sending due to -d debug dry-run) $ LC_ALL=C mail -d -:/ -Sv15-compat -Sttycharset=utf8 \ -S mta=smtps://mylogin@exam.ple:465 -Ssmtp-auth=none \ -S from=scriptreply@exam.ple \ -a /etc/mail.rc --end-options \ eric@exam.ple < /tmp/letter.txt
Email addresses and plain user names are subject to
alternates
filtering, names only are first expanded
through alias
and mta-aliases.
An address in angle brackets consisting only of a valid local user
‘<name>
’ will be converted to a
fully qualified address if either hostname is not set,
or set to a non-empty value; if set to the empty value the conversion is
left up to the mta. By setting
expandaddr fine-grained control of recipient address
types other than user names and network addresses is possible. Recipients
are classified as follows: any name that starts with a vertical bar
‘|
’ character specifies a command pipe
– the command string following the
‘|
’ is executed and the message is
sent to its standard input; likewise, any name that consists only of
hyphen-minus ‘-
’ or starts with the
character solidus ‘/
’ or the character
sequence dot solidus ‘./
’ is treated
as a file, regardless of the remaining content. Any other name which
contains a commercial at ‘@
’ character
is a network address; Any other name which starts with a plus sign
‘+
’ character is a mailbox name; Any
other name which contains a solidus
‘/
’ character but no exclamation mark
‘!
’ or percent sign
‘%
’ character before is also a mailbox
name; What remains is treated as a network address. This classification can
be avoided by using a ‘Fcc:
’ header,
see Compose mode.
$ echo bla | mail -Sexpandaddr -s test ./mbox.mbox $ echo bla | mail -Sexpandaddr -s test '|cat >> ./mbox.mbox' $ echo safe | LC_ALL=C \ mail -:/ -Smta=test -Sv15-compat -Sttycharset=utf8 \ --set mime-force-sendout --set fullnames \ -S expandaddr=fail,-all,+addr,failinvaddr -s test \ --end-options 'Imagine John <cold@turk.ey>'
Before messages are sent they undergo editing in
Compose mode. But many settings are
static and can be set more generally. The envelope sender address for
example is defined by from, explicitly defining an
originating hostname may be desirable, especially with
the built-in SMTP Mail-Transfer-Agent mta.
Character sets for outgoing message
and MIME part content are configurable via
sendcharsets, whereas input data is assumed to be in
ttycharset. Message data will be passed over the wire
in a mime-encoding, and MIME parts aka attachments
need a mimetype
, usually taken out of
The mime.types files. Saving
copies of sent messages in a record mailbox may be
desirable – as for most mailbox folder
targets Filename
transformations will be performed.
For the purpose of arranging a complete environment of settings
that can be switched to with a single command or command line option there
are account
s. Alternatively a flat configuration
could be possible, making use of so-called variable chains which
automatically pick ‘USER@HOST
’ or
‘HOST
’ context-dependent variants some
variables support: for example addressing
‘
’ would find
pop3-no-apop-yaa@exam.ple,
pop3-no-apop-exam.ple and
pop3-no-apop in order. For more please see
On URL syntax and
credential lookup and INTERNAL
VARIABLES.Folder
pop3://yaa@exam.ple
To avoid environmental noise scripts should create a script-local
environment, ideally with the command line options
-:
to disable configuration files in conjunction
with repetitions of -S
to specify variables:
$ env LC_ALL=C mail -:/ \ -Sv15-compat \ -Sttycharset=utf-8 -Smime-force-sendout \ -Sexpandaddr=fail,-all,failinvaddr \ -S mta=smtps://mylogin@exam.ple:465 -Ssmtp-auth=login \ -S from=scriptreply@exam.ple \ -s 'Subject to go' -a attachment_file \ -Sfullnames -. \ 'Recipient 1 <rec1@exam.ple>' rec2@exam.ple \ < content_file
As shown, scripts producing messages can “fake” a
locale environment, the above specifies the all-compatible 7-bit clean
LC_ALL
“C”, but will nonetheless take
and send UTF-8 in the message text by using
ttycharset. If character set conversion is compiled in
(features includes the term
‘,+iconv,
’) invalid (according to
ttycharset) character input data would normally cause
errors; setting mime-force-sendout will instead, as a
last resort, classify the input as binary data, and therefore allow message
creation to be successful. (Such content can then be inspected either by
installing a pipe-TYPE/SUBTYPE handler for
‘application/octet-stream
’, or
possibly automatically through
mime-counter-evidence).
In interactive mode, introduced soon, messages can be sent by
calling the mail
command with a list of recipient
addresses:
$ mail -:/ -Squiet -Semptystart -Sfullnames -Smta=test "/var/spool/mail/user": 0 messages ? mail "Recipient 1 <rec1@exam.ple>", rec2@exam.ple ... ? # Will do the right thing (tm) ? m rec1@exam.ple rec2@exam.ple
Compose mode
If standard input is a terminal rather than the message to be
sent, the user is expected to type in the message contents. In compose mode
lines beginning with the character ‘~
’
(in fact the value of escape) are special –
these are so-called COMMAND
ESCAPES which can be used to read in files, process shell commands, add
and edit attachments and more. For example ~v
or
~e
will start the VISUAL
text EDITOR
, respectively, to revise the message in
its current state, ~h
allows editing of the most
important message headers, with the potent ~^
custom
headers can be created, for example (more specifically than with
-C
and customhdr).
[Option]ally ~?
gives an overview of most other
available command escapes.
To create file-carbon-copies the special recipient header
‘Fcc:
’ may be used as often as
desired, for example via ~^
. Its entire value (or
body in standard terms) is interpreted as a folder
target, after having been subject to
Filename transformations:
this is the only way to create a file-carbon-copy without introducing an
ambiguity regarding the interpretation of the address, file names with
leading vertical bars or commercial ats can be used. Like all other
recipients ‘Fcc:
’ is subject to the
checks of expandaddr. Any local file and pipe command
addressee honours the setting of mbox-fcc-and-pcc.
Once finished with editing the command escape
~.
(see there) will call hooks, insert automatic
injections and receivers, leave compose mode and send the message once it is
completed. Aborting letter composition is possible with either of
~x
or ~q
, the latter of
which will save the message in the file denoted by
DEAD
unless nosave is set. And
unless ignoreeof is set the effect of
~.
can also be achieved by typing
end-of-transmission (EOT) via
‘control-D
’
(‘^D
’) at the beginning of an empty
line, and ~q
is always reachable by typing
end-of-text (ETX) twice via
‘control-C
’
(‘^C
’).
The compose mode hooks on-compose-enter,
on-compose-splice,
on-compose-leave and
on-compose-cleanup may be set to
define
d macros and provide reliable and increasingly
powerful mechanisms to perform automated message adjustments dependent on
message context, for example addition of message signatures
(message-inject-head,
message-inject-tail) or creation of additional
receiver lists (also by setting autocc,
autobcc). To achieve that the command
digmsg
may be used in order to query and adjust
status of message(s). The splice hook can also make use of
COMMAND ESCAPES. ([v15 behaviour
may differ] The compose mode hooks work for forward
,
mail
, reply
and variants;
resend
and Resend
only
provide the hooks on-resend-enter and
on-resend-cleanup, which are pretty restricted due to
the nature of the operation.)
On reading mail, and more on interactive mode
When invoked without addressees Mail enters interactive mode in
which mails may be read. When used like that the user's system
inbox (for more on mailbox types please see the
command folder
) is read in and a one line header of
each message therein is displayed if the variable
header is set. The visual style of this summary of
headers
can be adjusted through the variable
headline and the possible sorting criterion via
autosort. Scrolling through
screenfuls of headers
can be
performed with the command z
. If the initially
opened mailbox is empty Mail will instead exit immediately (after displaying
a message) unless the variable emptystart is set.
At the prompt the command
list
will give a listing of all available commands
and help
will [Option]ally give a summary of some
common ones. If the [Option]al documentation strings are available (see
features) one can type ‘help
X
’ (or ‘?X
’) and see the
actual expansion of ‘X
’ and what its
purpose is, i.e., commands can be abbreviated (note that POSIX defines some
abbreviations, so that the alphabetical order of commands does not
necessarily relate to the abbreviations; it is however possible to define
overwrites with commandalias
). These commands can
also produce a more verbose output.
Messages are given numbers (starting at 1) which uniquely identify
messages; the current message – the “dot” – will
either be the first new message, or the first unread message, or the first
message of the mailbox; the internal variable showlast
will instead cause usage of the last message for this purpose. The command
headers
will display a
screenful of header summaries containing the
“dot”, whereas from
will display only
the summaries of the given messages, defaulting to the
“dot”.
Message content can be displayed with the command
type
(‘t
’,
alias print
). Here the variable
crt controls whether and when Mail will use the
configured PAGER
for display instead of directly
writing to the user terminal screen, the sole
difference to the command more
, which will always
use the PAGER
. The command
top
will instead only show the first
toplines of a message (maybe even compressed if
topsqueeze is set). Message display experience may
improve by setting and adjusting
mime-counter-evidence, and also see
HTML mail and MIME
attachments.
By default the current message (“dot”) is displayed,
but like with many other commands it is possible to give a fancy message
specification (see Specifying
messages), for example ‘t:u
’ will
display all unread messages, ‘t.
’ will
display the “dot”, ‘t 1
5
’ will type the messages 1 and 5, ‘t
1-5
’ will type the messages 1 through 5, and
‘t-
’ and
‘t+
’ will display the previous and the
next message, respectively. The command search
(a
more substantial alias for from
) will display a
header summary of the given message specification list instead of their
content; the following will search for subjects:
? from '@Some subject to search
for'
In the default setup all header fields of a message will be
type
d, but fields can be white- or blacklisted for a
variety of applications by using the command
headerpick
, e.g., to restrict their display to a
very restricted set for type
:
‘
’. In order to display all header fields of a
message regardless of currently active ignore or retain lists, use the
commands headerpick
type retain
from to cc
subjectType
and Top
;
Show
will show the raw message content. Note that
historically the global mail.rc not only adjusts the
list of displayed headers, but also sets crt. ([v15
behaviour may differ] A yet somewhat restricted) Reliable scriptable message
inspection is available via digmsg
.
Dependent upon the configuration a line editor (see the section
On terminal
control and line editor) aims at making the user experience with the
many COMMANDS a bit nicer. When reading
the system inbox, or when -f
(or folder
) specified a mailbox explicitly prefixed
with the special ‘%:
’ modifier (to
propagate it to a primary
system mailbox), then messages which have been read
(see Message states) will be
automatically moved to a secondary
mailbox, the user's MBOX
file, when the mailbox
is left, either by changing the active mailbox or by quitting Mail –
this automatic moving from a system- or primary- to the secondary mailbox is
not performed when the variable hold is set. Messages
can also be explicitly move
d to other mailboxes,
whereas copy
keeps the original message.
write
can be used to write out data content of
specific parts of messages.
After examining a message the user can
reply
‘r
’ to
the sender and all recipients (which will also be placed in
‘To:
’ unless
recipients-in-cc is set), or
Reply
‘R
’
exclusively to the sender(s). To comply with with the receivers desired
reply address the quadoptions
followup-to-honour and
reply-to-honour should usually be set. The commands
Lreply
and Lfollowup
know
how to apply a special addressee massage, see
Mailing lists. Dependent on the
presence and value of quote the message being replied
to will be included in a quoted form. forward
ing a
message will allow editing the new message: the original message will be
contained in the message body, adjusted according to
headerpick
. It is possible to
resend
or Resend
messages:
the former will add a series of
‘Resent-
’ headers, whereas the latter
will not; different to newly created messages editing is not possible and no
copy will be saved even with record unless the
additional variable record-resent is set. When
sending, replying or forwarding messages comments and full names will be
stripped from recipient addresses unless the internal variable
fullnames is set.
Of course messages can be delete
‘d
’, and they can spring into
existence again via undelete
, or when the Mail
session is ended via the exit
or
xit
commands to perform a quick program termation.
To end a mail processing session regularly and perform a full program exit
one may issue the command quit
. It will, among
others, move read messages to the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
as necessary, discard deleted messages in the
current mailbox, and update the [Option]al (see
features) line editor
history-file. By the way, whenever the main event loop
is about to look out for the next input line it will trigger the hook
on-main-loop-tick.
HTML mail and MIME attachments
HTML-only messages become more and more common, and many messages
come bundled with a bouquet of MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions)
parts and attachments. To get a notion of MIME types there is a built-in
default set, onto which the content of
The mime.types files will be
added (as configured and allowed by
mimetypes-load-control). Types can also become
registered and listed with the command mimetype
. To
improve interaction with the faulty MIME part declarations of real life
mime-counter-evidence will allow verification of the
given assertion, and the possible provision of an alternative, better MIME
type. Note plain text parts will always be preferred in
‘multipart/alternative
’ MIME messages
unless mime-alternative-favour-rich is set.
Whereas a simple HTML-to-text filter for displaying HTML messages
is [Option]ally supported (indicated by
‘,+filter-html-tagsoup,
’ in
features), MIME types other than plain text cannot be
handled directly. To deal with specific non-text MIME types or file
extensions programs need to be registered which either prepare
(re-)integrable plain text versions of their input (a mode which is called
copiousoutput
), or display the content externally,
for example in a graphical window: the latter type is only considered by and
for the command mimeview
.
To install a handler program for a MIME type an according
pipe-TYPE/SUBTYPE variable needs to be set; to define
a handler for a file extension pipe-EXTENSION can be
used – these handlers take precedence. [Option]ally mail user agent
configuration is supported (see The
Mailcap files), and will be queried for display or quote handlers after
the former ones. Type-markers registered via
mimetype
are the last possible source for
information how to handle a MIME type.
For example, to display HTML messages integrated via the text browsers lynx(1) or elinks(1), register a MathML MIME type and enable its plain text display, and to open PDF attachments in an external PDF viewer, asynchronously and with some other magic attached:
? if "$features" !% ,+filter-html-tagsoup, ? #set pipe-text/html='?* elinks -force-html -dump 1' ? set pipe-text/html='?* lynx -stdin -dump -force_html' ? # Display HTML as plain text instead ? #set pipe-text/html=?t ? endif ? mimetype ?t application/mathml+xml mathml ? wysh set pipe-application/pdf='?&=? \ trap "rm -f \"${MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY}\"" EXIT;\ trap "trap \"\" INT QUIT TERM; exit 1" INT QUIT TERM;\ mupdf "${MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY}"' ? define showhtml { ? \localopts yes ? \set mime-alternative-favour-rich pipe-text/html=?h? ? \type "$@" ? } ? \commandalias html \\call showhtml
Mailing lists
Known or subscribed-to mailing lists may be flagged in the summary
of headers
(headline format
character ‘%L
’), and will gain special
treatment when sending mails: the variable
followup-to-honour will ensure that a
‘Mail-Followup-To:
’ header is honoured
when a message is being replied to (reply
,
followup
, Lreply
,
Lfollowup
), and followup-to
controls creation of this header when creating
mail
s, if the necessary user setup (from, sender);
is available; then, it may also be created automatically, for example when
list-replying via Lreply
or
Lfollowup
, when followup
or
reply
is used and the messages
‘Mail-Followup-To:
’ is honoured
etc.
The commands mlist
and
mlsubscribe
manage Mails notion of which addresses
are mailing lists. With the [Option]al regular expression support any
address which contains any of the magic regular expression characters
(‘^[*+?|$
’; see
re_format(7) or
regex(7), dependent on the host
system) will be compiled and used as one, possibly matching many addresses.
It is not possible to escape the “magic”: in order to match
special characters as-is, bracket expressions must be used, for example
‘
’.search
@subject@'[[]open bracket'
? set followup-to followup-to-honour=ask-yes \ reply-to-honour=ask-yes ? mlist a1@b1.c1 a2@b2.c2 '.*@lists\.c3$' ? mlsubscribe a4@b4.c4 exact@lists.c3
Known and subscribed lists differ in that for the latter the
users address is not part of a generated
‘Mail-Followup-To:
’. There are
exceptions, for example if multiple lists are addressed and not all have the
subscription attribute. When replying to a message its list address
(‘List-Post:
’ header) is automatically
and temporarily treated like a known mlist
;
dependent on the variable reply-to-honour an existing
‘Reply-To:
’ is used instead (if it is
a single address on the same domain as
‘List-Post:
’) in order to accept a
list administrator's wish that is supposed to have been manifested like
that.
For convenience and compatibility with mail programs that do not
honour the non-standard M-F-T, an automatic user entry in the carbon-copy
‘Cc:
’ address list of generated
message can be created by setting followup-to-add-cc.
This entry will be added whenever the user will be placed in the
‘Mail-Followup-To:
’ list, and is not a
regular addressee already. reply-to-swap-in tries to
deal with the address rewriting that many mailing-lists nowadays perform to
work around DKIM / DMARC etc. standard imposed problems.
Signed and encrypted messages with S/MIME
[Option] S/MIME provides two central mechanisms: message signing and message encryption. A signed message contains some data in addition to the regular text. The data can be used to verify that the message has been sent using a valid certificate, that the sender address matches that in the certificate, and that the message text has not been altered. Signing a message does not change its regular text; it can be read regardless of whether the recipients software is able to handle S/MIME. It is thus usually possible to sign all outgoing messages if so desired.
Encryption, in contrast, makes the message text invisible for all people except those who have access to the secret decryption key. To encrypt a message, the specific recipients public encryption key must be known. It is therefore not possible to send encrypted mail to people unless their key has been retrieved from either previous communication or public key directories. Because signing is performed with private keys, and encryption with public keys, messages should always be signed before being encrypted.
A central concept to S/MIME is that of the certification authority (CA). A CA is a trusted institution that issues certificates. For each of these certificates it can be verified that it really originates from the CA, provided that the CA's own certificate is previously known. A set of CA certificates is usually delivered and installed together with the cryptographical library that is used on the local system. Therefore reasonable security for S/MIME on the Internet is provided if the source that provides that library installation is trusted. It is also possible to use a specific pool of trusted certificates. If this is desired, smime-ca-no-defaults should be set to avoid using the default certificate pool, and smime-ca-file and/or smime-ca-dir should be pointed to a trusted pool of certificates. A certificate cannot be more secure than the method its CA certificate has been retrieved with.
This trusted pool of certificates is used by the command
verify
to ensure that the given S/MIME messages can
be trusted. If so, verified sender certificates that were embedded in signed
messages can be saved locally with the command
certsave
, and used by Mail to encrypt further
communication with these senders:
? certsave FILENAME ? set smime-encrypt-USER@HOST=FILENAME \ smime-cipher-USER@HOST=AES256
To sign outgoing messages, in order to allow receivers to verify the origin of these messages, a personal S/MIME certificate is required. Mail supports password-protected personal certificates (and keys), see smime-sign-cert. The section On URL syntax and credential lookup gives an overview of the possible sources of user credentials, and S/MIME step by step shows examplarily how a private S/MIME certificate can be obtained. In general, if such a private key plus certificate “pair” is available, all that needs to be done is to set some variables:
? set smime-sign-cert=ME@exam.ple.paired \ smime-sign-digest=SHA512 \ smime-sign from=myname@my.host
Variables of interest for S/MIME in general are
smime-ca-dir, smime-ca-file,
smime-ca-flags,
smime-ca-no-defaults,
smime-crl-dir, smime-crl-file.
For S/MIME signing of interest are smime-sign,
smime-sign-cert,
smime-sign-include-certs and
smime-sign-digest. Additional variables of interest
for S/MIME en- and decryption: smime-cipher and
smime-encrypt-USER@HOST. Variables of secondary
interest may be content-description-smime-message and
content-description-smime-signature. S/MIME is
available if ‘,+smime,
’ is included in
features.
[v15 behaviour may differ] Note that neither S/MIME signing nor encryption applies to message subjects or other header fields yet. Thus they may not contain sensitive information for encrypted messages, and cannot be trusted even if the message content has been verified. When sending signed messages, it is recommended to repeat any important header information in the message text.
On URL syntax and credential lookup
For accessing protocol-specific resources Uniform Resource
Locators (URL, RFC 3986) have become omnipresent. Here they are expected in
a “normalized” variant, not used in data exchange, but only
meant as a compact, easy-to-use way of defining and representing information
in a well-known notation; as such they do not conform to any real standard.
Optional parts are placed in brackets
‘[]
’, optional either because there
also exist other ways to define the information, or because the part is
protocol specific. ‘/path
’ for example
is used by the [Option]al Maildir folder
type and
the IMAP protocol, but not by POP3. If
‘USER
’ and
‘PASSWORD
’ are included in an URL
server specification, URL percent encoded (RFC 3986) forms are needed,
generable with urlcodec
.
PROTOCOL://[USER[:PASSWORD]@]server[:port][/path]
Often INTERNAL
VARIABLES exist in multiple versions, called “variable
chains” in this document: the plain
‘variable
’ as well as
‘variable-HOST
’ and
‘variable-USER@HOST
’. If a port was
specified ‘HOST
’ really means
‘server:port
’, not
‘server
’. And this
‘USER
’ is never in URL percent encoded
form. For example, whether the hypothetical
‘smtp://wings%3Aof@a.dove
’ including
user and password was used, or whether it was
‘smtp://a.dove
’ and it came from a
different source, to lookup the chain tls-config-pairs
first
‘tls-config-pairs-wings:of@a.dove
’ is
looked up, then
‘tls-config-pairs-a.dove
’, before
finally looking up the plain variable.
The logic to collect (an account
s)
credential information is as follows:
- A user is always required. If no
‘
USER
’ has been given in the URL the variables user-HOST and user are looked up. Afterwards, when enforced by the [Option]al variables netrc-lookup-HOST or netrc-lookup, The .netrc file of the user will be searched for a ‘HOST
’ specific entry which provides a ‘login
’ name: only unambiguous entries are used (one possible matching entry for ‘HOST
’).If there is still no ‘
USER
’ then the verifiedLOGNAME
, known to be a valid user on the current host, is used. - Authentication: unless otherwise noted the chain PROTOCOL-auth-USER@HOST, PROTOCOL-auth-HOST, PROTOCOL-auth is checked, falling back to a protocol-specific default as necessary.
- If no ‘
PASSWORD
’ has been given in the URL, then if the ‘USER
’ has been found through the [Option]al netrc-lookup, that may have also provided the password. Otherwise the chain password-USER@HOST, password-HOST, password is looked up.Thereafter the (now complete) [Option]al chain netrc-lookup-USER@HOST, netrc-lookup-HOST, netrc-lookup is checked, if set the
netrc
cache is searched for a password only (multiple user accounts for a single machine may exist as well as a fallback entry without user but with a password).If at that point there is still no password available, but the (protocols') chosen authentication type requires a password, then in interactive mode the user will be prompted on the terminal.
Note: S/MIME verification works relative to the
values found in the ‘From:
’ (or
‘Sender:
’) header field(s), which
means the values of smime-sign,
smime-sign-cert,
smime-sign-include-certs and
smime-sign-digest will not be looked up using the
‘USER
’ and
‘HOST
’ chains from above, but instead
use the corresponding values from the message that is being worked on. If no
address matches we assume and use the setting of from.
In unusual cases multiple and different
‘USER
’ and
‘HOST
’ combinations may therefore be
involved – on the other hand those unusual cases become possible. The
usual case is as short as:
set mta=smtp://USER:PASS@HOST smtp-use-starttls \ smime-sign smime-sign-cert=+smime.pair \ from=myname@my.host
The section EXAMPLES contains complete example configurations.
Encrypted network communication
[Option] SSL (Secure Sockets Layer) aka its successor TLS (Transport Layer Security) are protocols which aid in securing communication by providing a safely initiated and encrypted network connection. A central concept of TLS are certificates: as part of each network connection setup a (set of) certificates will be exchanged through which the identity of the network peer can be cryptographically verified; if possible the TLS/SNI (ServerNameIndication) extension will be enabled to allow servers fine-grained control over the certificates being used. A locally installed pool of trusted certificates will then be inspected, and verification will succeed if it contains a(n in)direct signer of the presented certificate(s).
The local pool of trusted so-called CA (Certification Authority)
certificates is usually delivered with and used along the TLS library. A
custom pool of trusted certificates can be selected by pointing
tls-ca-file and/or (with special preparation)
tls-ca-dir to the desired location; setting
tls-ca-no-defaults in addition will avoid additional
inspection of the default pool. A certificate cannot be more secure than the
method its CA certificate has been retrieved with. For inspection or other
purposes, the certificate of a server (as seen when connecting to it) can be
fetched with the command tls
(port can usually be
the protocol name, too, and tls-verify is taken into
account here):
$ mail -vX 'tls certchain SERVER-URL[:PORT]; x'
A local pool of CA certificates is not strictly necessary,
however, server certificates can also be verified via their fingerprint. For
this a message digest will be calculated and compared against the variable
chain tls-fingerprint, and verification will succeed
if the fingerprint matches. The message digest (algorithm) can be configured
via the variable chain tls-fingerprint-digest;
tls
can again be used:
$ mail -X 'wysh set verbose; tls fingerprint SERVER-URL[:PORT]; x'
It depends on the used protocol whether encrypted communication is
possible, and which configuration steps have to be taken to enable it. Some
protocols, like POP3S, are implicitly encrypted, others, like POP3, can
upgrade a plain text connection if so requested. For example, to use the
‘STLS
’ that POP3 offers (a member of)
the variable (chain) pop3-use-starttls needs to be
set, with convenience via shortcut
:
shortcut encpop1 pop3s://pop1.exam.ple shortcut encpop2 pop3://pop2.exam.ple set pop3-use-starttls-pop2.exam.ple set mta=smtps://smtp.exam.ple:465 set mta=smtp://smtp.exam.ple smtp-use-starttls
Normally that is all there is to do, given that TLS libraries try to provide safe defaults, plenty of knobs however exist to adjust settings. For example certificate verification settings can be fine-tuned via tls-ca-flags, and the TLS configuration basics are accessible via tls-config-pairs, for example to control protocol versions or cipher lists. In the past hints on how to restrict the set of protocols to highly secure ones were indicated, but as of the time of this writing the list of protocols or ciphers may need to become relaxed in order to be able to connect to some servers; the following example allows connecting to a “Lion” that uses OpenSSL 0.9.8za from June 2014 (refer to INTERNAL VARIABLES for more on variable chains):
wysh set tls-config-pairs-lion@exam.ple='MinProtocol=TLSv1.1,\ CipherString=TLSv1.2:!aNULL:!eNULL:\ ECDHE-RSA-AES256-SHA:ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-SHA:\ DHE-RSA-AES256-SHA:@STRENGTH'
The OpenSSL program
ciphers(1) should be referred to
when creating a custom cipher list. Variables of interest for TLS in general
are tls-ca-dir, tls-ca-file,
tls-ca-flags,
tls-ca-no-defaults,
tls-config-file,
tls-config-module,
tls-config-pairs, tls-crl-dir,
tls-crl-file, tls-rand-file as
well as tls-verify. Also see
tls-features. TLS is available if
‘+tls
’ is included in
features.
Character sets
[Option] The user's locale environment is detected by looking at
the LC_ALL
environment variable. The internal
variable ttycharset will be set to the detected
terminal character set accordingly, and will thus show up in the output of
commands like set
and
varshow
. This character set will be targeted when
trying to display data, and user input data is expected to be in this
character set, too.
When creating messages their character input data is classified.
7-bit clean text data and attachments will be classified as
charset-7bit. 8-bit data will [Option]ally be
converted into members of sendcharsets until a
character set conversion succeeds. charset-8bit is the
implied default last member of this list. If no 8-bit character set is
capable to represent input data, no message will be sent, and its text will
optionally be saved in DEAD
.
If that is not acceptable, for example in script environments,
mime-force-sendout can be set to force sending of
non-convertible data as
‘application/octet-stream
’ classified
binary content instead: like this receivers still have the option to inspect
message content (for example via
mime-counter-evidence). If the [Option]al character
set conversion is not available (features misses
‘,+iconv,
’),
ttycharset is the only supported character set for non
7-bit clean data, and it is simply assumed it can be used to exchange 8-bit
messages.
ttycharset may also be given an explicit
value to send mail in a completely “faked” locale environment,
which can be used to generate and send for example 8-bit UTF-8 input data in
a pure 7-bit US-ASCII ‘LC_ALL=C
’
environment (an example of this can be found in the section
On sending
mail, and non-interactive mode). Due to lack of programming interfaces
reading mail will not really work as expected in a faked environment:
whereas ttycharset might be addressable, any output
will be made safely printable, as via vexpr
makeprint
, according to the actual locale
environment, which is not affected by ttycharset.
Classifying 7-bit clean data as charset-7bit is a problem if the input character set (ttycharset) is a multibyte character set that is itself 7-bit clean. For example, the Japanese character set ISO-2022-JP is, but is capable to encode the rich set of Japanese Kanji, Hiragana and Katakana characters: in order to notify receivers of this character set the mail message must be MIME encoded so that the character set ISO-2022-JP can be advertised, otherwise an invalid email message would result! To achieve this, the variable charset-7bit can be set to ISO-2022-JP. (Today a better approach regarding email is the usage of UTF-8, which uses 8-bit bytes for non-US-ASCII data.)
When replying to a message and the variable
reply-in-same-charset is set, the character set of the
message being replied to is tried first as a target character set (still
being a subject of charsetalias
filtering, however).
Another opportunity is sendcharsets-else-ttycharset to
reflect the user's locale environment automatically, it will treat
ttycharset as an implied member of (an unset)
sendcharsets.
[Option] When reading messages, their text data is converted into
ttycharset as necessary in order to display them on
the user's terminal. Unprintable characters and invalid byte sequences are
detected and replaced by substitution characters. Character set mappings for
source character sets can be established with
charsetalias
, which may be handy to work around
faulty or incomplete character set catalogues (one could for example add a
missing LATIN1 to ISO-8859-1 mapping), or to enforce treatment of one
character set as another one (“interpret LATIN1 as CP1252”).
Also see charset-unknown-8bit to deal with another
hairy aspect of message interpretation.
In general, if a message saying “cannot convert from a to
b” appears, either some characters are not appropriate for the
currently selected (terminal) character set, or the needed conversion is not
supported by the system. In the first case, it is necessary to set an
appropriate LC_CTYPE
locale and/or the variable
ttycharset. The best results are usually achieved when
running in a UTF-8 locale on a UTF-8 capable terminal, in which case the
full Unicode spectrum of characters is available. In this setup characters
from various countries can be displayed, while it is still possible to use
more simple character sets for sending to retain maximum compatibility with
older mail clients.
On the other hand the POSIX standard defines a locale-independent
7-bit “portable character set” that should be used when
overall portability is an issue, the even more restricted subset named
“portable filename character set” consists of A-Z, a-z, 0-9,
period ‘.
’, underscore
‘_
’ and hyphen-minus
‘-
’.
Message states
Mail differentiates in between several message states; the current
state will be reflected in the summary of headers
if
the attrlist of the configured
headline allows, and
Specifying messages dependent
on their state is possible. When operating on the system
inbox, or in any other
primary system mailbox,
special actions, like the automatic moving of messages to the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
, may be applied when the mailbox is left (also
implicitly by program termination, unless the command
exit
was used) – however, because this may be
irritating to users which are used to “more modern”
mail-user-agents, the provided global mail.rc
template sets the internal hold and
keepsave variables in order to suppress this
behaviour.
- ‘
new
’ - Message has neither been viewed nor moved to any other state. Such messages are retained even in the primary system mailbox.
- ‘
unread
’ - Message has neither been viewed nor moved to any other state, but the message was present already when the mailbox has been opened last: Such messages are retained even in the primary system mailbox.
- ‘
read
’ - The message has been processed by one of the following commands:
~f
,~m
,~F
,~M
,copy
,mbox
,next
,pipe
,Print
,print
,top
,Type
,type
,undelete
. The commandsdp
anddt
will always try to automatically “step” andtype
the “next” logical message, and may thus mark multiple messages as read, thedelete
command will do so if the internal variable autoprint is set.Except when the
exit
command is used, messages that are in a primary system mailbox and are in ‘read
’ state when the mailbox is left will be saved in the secondary mailboxMBOX
unless the internal variable hold it set. - ‘
deleted
’ - The message has been processed by one of the following commands:
delete
,dp
,dt
. Onlyundelete
can be used to access such messages. - ‘
preserved
’ - The message has been processed by a
preserve
command and it will be retained in its current location. - ‘
saved
’ - The message has been processed by one of the following commands:
save
orwrite
. Unless when theexit
command is used, messages that are in a primary system mailbox and are in ‘saved
’ state when the mailbox is left will be deleted; they will be saved in the secondary mailboxMBOX
when the internal variable keepsave is set.
In addition to these message states, flags which otherwise have no technical meaning in the mail system except allowing special ways of addressing them when Specifying messages can be set on messages. These flags are saved with messages and are thus persistent, and are portable between a set of widely used MUAs.
Specifying messages
[Only new quoting rules] COMMANDS
which
take Message list
arguments, such as search
,
type
, copy
, and
delete
, can perform actions on a number of messages
at once. Specifying invalid messages, or using illegal syntax, will cause
errors to be reported through the
INTERNAL VARIABLES
!, ^ERR and companions, as well
as the command exit status ?.
For example, ‘delete 1 2
’
deletes the messages 1 and 2, whereas ‘delete
1-5
’ will delete the messages 1 through 5. In sorted or
threaded mode (see the sort
command),
‘delete 1-5
’ will delete the messages
that are located between (and including) messages 1 through 5 in the
sorted/threaded order, as shown in the headers
summary.
Errors can for example be ^ERR-BADMSG when requesting an invalid message, ^ERR-NOMSG if no applicable message can be found, ^ERR-CANCELED for missing informational data (mostly thread-related). ^ERR-INVAL for invalid syntax as well as ^ERR-IO for input/output errors can happen. The following special message names exist:
- .
- The current message, the so-called “dot”.
- ;
- The message that was previously the current message; needs to be quoted.
- ,
- The parent message of the current message, that is the message with the
Message-ID given in the
‘
In-Reply-To:
’ field or the last entry of the ‘References:
’ field of the current message. - -
- The previous undeleted message, or the previous deleted message for the
undelete
command; Insort
ed or ‘thread
’ed mode, the previous such message in the according order. - +
- The next undeleted message, or the next deleted message for the
undelete
command; Insort
ed or ‘thread
’ed mode, the next such message in the according order. - ^
- The first undeleted message, or the first deleted message for the
undelete
command; Insort
ed or ‘thread
’ed mode, the first such message in the according order. - $
- The last message; In
sort
ed or ‘thread
’ed mode, the last such message in the according order. Needs to be quoted. - &x
- In ‘
thread
’edsort
mode, selects the message addressed with x, where x is any other message specification, and all messages from the thread that begins at it. Otherwise it is identical to x. If x is omitted, the thread beginning with the current message is selected. - *
- All messages.
- `
- All messages that were included in the
Message list arguments of
the previous command; needs to be quoted. (A convenient way to read all
new messages is to select them via ‘
from :n
’, as below, and then to read them in order with the default command —next
— simply by successively typing ‘`
’; for this to work showlast must be set.) - x-y
- An inclusive range of message numbers. Selectors that may also be used as endpoints include any of .;-+^$.
- address
- A case-insensitive “any substring matches” search against
the ‘
From:
’ header, which will match addresses (too) even if showname is set (and POSIX says “any address as shown in a header summary shall be matchable in this form”); However, if the allnet variable is set, only the local part of the address is evaluated for the comparison, not ignoring case, and the setting of showname is completely ignored. For finer control and match boundaries use the ‘@
’ search expression. - /string
- All messages that contain string in the subject field (case ignored according to locale). See also the searchheaders variable. If string is empty, the string from the previous specification of that type is used again.
- [@name-list]@expr
- All messages that contain the given case-insensitive search
expression; If the [Option]al regular expression
support is available expr will be interpreted as (an
extended) one if any of the
magic regular
expression characters is seen. If the optional
@name-list part is missing the
search is restricted to the subject field body, but otherwise
name-list specifies a comma-separated list of header
fields to search, for example
'@to,from,cc@Someone i ought to know'
In order to search for a string that includes a ‘
@
’ (commercial at) character the name-list is effectively non-optional, but may be given as the empty string. Also, specifying an empty search expression will effectively test for existence of the given header fields. Some special header fields may be abbreviated: ‘f
’, ‘t
’, ‘c
’, ‘b
’ and ‘s
’ will match ‘From
’, ‘To
’, ‘Cc
’, ‘Bcc
’ and ‘Subject
’, respectively and case-insensitively. [Option]ally, and just like expr, name-list will be interpreted as (an extended) regular expression if any of the magic regular expression characters is seen.The special names ‘
header
’ or ‘<
’ can be used to search in (all of) the header(s) of the message, and the special names ‘body
’ or ‘>
’ and ‘text
’ or ‘=
’ will perform full text searches – whereas the former searches only the body, the latter also searches the message header ([v15 behaviour may differ] this mode yet brute force searches over the entire decoded content of messages, including administrativa strings).This specification performs full text comparison, but even with regular expression support it is almost impossible to write a search expression that safely matches only a specific address domain. To request that the body content of the header is treated as a list of addresses, and to strip those down to the plain email address which the search expression is to be matched against, prefix the effective name-list with a tilde ‘
~
’:'@~f,c@@a\.safe\.domain\.match$'
- :c
- All messages of state or with matching condition
‘
c
’, where ‘c
’ is one or multiple of the following colon modifiers:- a
answered
messages (cf. the variable markanswered).- d
- ‘
deleted
’ messages (for theundelete
andfrom
commands only). - f
flag
ged messages.- L
- Messages with receivers that match
mlsubscribe
d addresses. - l
- Messages with receivers that match
mlist
ed addresses. - n
- ‘
new
’ messages. - o
- Old messages (any not in state
‘
read
’ or ‘new
’). - r
- ‘
read
’ messages. - S
- [Option] Messages with unsure spam classification (see Handling spam).
- s
- [Option] Messages classified as spam.
- t
- Messages marked as
draft
. - u
- ‘
unread
’ messages.
[Option] IMAP-style SEARCH expressions may also be used. These
consist of keywords and criterions, and because
Message list arguments are
split into tokens according to
Shell-style argument
quoting it is necessary to quote the entire IMAP search expression in
order to ensure that it remains a single token. This addressing mode is
available with all types of mailbox folder
s; Mail
will perform the search locally as necessary. Strings must be enclosed by
double quotation marks ‘"
’ in
their entirety if they contain whitespace or parentheses; within the quotes,
only reverse solidus ‘\
’ is recognized
as an escape character. All string searches are case-insensitive. When the
description indicates that the “envelope” representation of an
address field is used, this means that the search string is checked against
both a list constructed as
'("name" "source" "local-part" "domain-part")'
for each address, and the addresses without real names from the respective header field. These search expressions can be nested using parentheses, see below for examples.
- (criterion)
- All messages that satisfy the given criterion.
- (criterion1 criterion2 ... criterionN)
- All messages that satisfy all of the given criteria.
- (or criterion1 criterion2)
- All messages that satisfy either criterion1 or
criterion2, or both. To connect more than two
criteria using ‘
or
’ specifications have to be nested using additional parentheses, as with ‘(or a (or b c))
’, since ‘(or a b c)
’ really means ‘((a or b) and c)
’. For a simple ‘or
’ operation of independent criteria on the lowest nesting level, it is possible to achieve similar effects by using three separate criteria, as with ‘(a) (b) (c)
’. - (not criterion)
- All messages that do not satisfy criterion.
- (bcc "string")
- All messages that contain string in the envelope
representation of the ‘
Bcc:
’ field. - (cc "string")
- All messages that contain string in the envelope
representation of the ‘
Cc:
’ field. - (from "string")
- All messages that contain string in the envelope
representation of the ‘
From:
’ field. - (subject "string")
- All messages that contain string in the
‘
Subject:
’ field. - (to "string")
- All messages that contain string in the envelope
representation of the ‘
To:
’ field. - (header name "string")
- All messages that contain string in the specified
‘
Name:
’ field. - (body "string")
- All messages that contain string in their body.
- (text "string")
- All messages that contain string in their header or body.
- (larger size)
- All messages that are larger than size (in bytes).
- (smaller size)
- All messages that are smaller than size (in bytes).
- (before date)
- All messages that were received before date, which
must be in the form ‘
d[d]-mon-yyyy
’, where ‘d
’ denotes the day of the month as one or two digits, ‘mon
’ is the name of the month – one of ‘Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec
’, and ‘yyyy
’ is the year as four digits, for example ‘28-Dec-2012
’. - (on date)
- All messages that were received on the specified date.
- (since date)
- All messages that were received since the specified date.
- (sentbefore date)
- All messages that were sent on the specified date.
- (senton date)
- All messages that were sent on the specified date.
- (sentsince date)
- All messages that were sent since the specified date.
- ()
- The same criterion as for the previous search. This specification cannot be used as part of another criterion. If the previous command line contained more than one independent criterion then the last of those criteria is used.
On terminal control and line editor
[Option] Terminal control through one of the standard
UNIX libraries, Termcap Access
Library (libtermcap, -ltermcap) or Terminal
Information Library (libterminfo, -lterminfo), may be available. For
the TERM
inal defined in the environment interactive
usage aspects, for example Coloured
display, and insight of cursor and function keys for the
Mailx-Line-Editor (MLE), will be enhanced or enabled. Library interaction
can be disabled on a per-invocation basis via
termcap-disable, whereas the internal variable
termcap is always used as a preferred source of
terminal capabilities. (For a usage example see the
FAQ entry
Not
"defunctional", but the editor key does not work.)
[Option] The built-in Mailx-Line-Editor (MLE) should work in all
environments which comply to the ISO C standard ISO/IEC
9899/AMD1:1995 (“ISO C90, Amendment 1”), and
will support wide glyphs if possible (the necessary functionality had been
removed from ISO C, but was included in X/Open Portability
Guide Issue 4 (“XPG4”)). Usage of a line editor
in interactive mode can be prevented by setting
line-editor-disable. Especially if the [Option]al
terminal control support is missing setting entries in
termcap will help shall the MLE misbehave, see there
for more. The MLE can support a little bit of
colour
.
[Option] If the history
feature is
available then input from line editor prompts will be saved in a history
list that can be searched in and be expanded from. Such saving can be
prevented by prefixing input with any amount of whitespace. Aspects of
history, like allowed content and maximum size, as well as whether history
shall be saved persistently, can be configured with the internal variables
history-file, history-gabby,
history-gabby-persist and
history-size. There also exists the macro hook
on-history-addition which can be used to apply finer
control on what enters history.
The MLE supports a set of editing and control commands. By default
(as) many (as possible) of these will be assigned to a set of single-letter
control codes, which should work on any terminal (and can be generated by
holding the “control” key while pressing the key of desire,
for example ‘control-D
’). If the
[Option]al bind
command is available then the MLE
commands can also be accessed freely by assigning the command name, which is
shown in parenthesis in the list below, to any desired key-sequence, and the
MLE will instead and also use bind
to establish its
built-in key bindings (more of them if the [Option]al terminal control is
available), an action which can then be suppressed completely by setting
line-editor-no-defaults.
Shell-style argument
quoting notation is used in the following:
- ‘
\cA
’ - Go to the start of the line (
mle-go-home
). - ‘
\cB
’ - Move the cursor backward one character
(
mle-go-bwd
). - ‘
\cC
’ - raise(3)
‘
SIGINT
’ (mle-raise-int
). - ‘
\cD
’ - Forward delete the character under the cursor; quits Mail if used on the
empty line unless the internal variable ignoreeof is
set (
mle-del-fwd
). - ‘
\cE
’ - Go to the end of the line (
mle-go-end
). - ‘
\cF
’ - Move the cursor forward one character
(
mle-go-fwd
). - ‘
\cG
’ - Cancel current operation, full reset. If there is an active history search
or tabulator expansion then this command will first reset that, reverting
to the former line content; thus a second reset is needed for a full reset
in this case (
mle-reset
). - ‘
\cH
’ - Backspace: backward delete one character
(
mle-del-bwd
). - ‘
\cI
’ - [Only new quoting rules] Horizontal tabulator: try to expand the word
before the cursor, supporting the usual
Filename
transformations (
mle-complete
; this is affected bymle-quote-rndtrip
and line-editor-cpl-word-breaks). - ‘
\cJ
’ - Newline: commit the current line
(
mle-commit
). - ‘
\cK
’ - Cut all characters from the cursor to the end of the line
(
mle-snarf-end
). - ‘
\cL
’ - Repaint the line (
mle-repaint
). - ‘
\cN
’ - [Option] Go to the next history entry
(
mle-hist-fwd
). - ‘
\cO
’ - ([Option]ally context-dependent) Invokes the command
dt
. - ‘
\cP
’ - [Option] Go to the previous history entry
(
mle-hist-bwd
). - ‘
\cQ
’ - Toggle roundtrip mode shell quotes, where produced, on and off
(
mle-quote-rndtrip
). This setting is temporary, and will be forgotten once the command line is committed; also seeshcodec
. - ‘
\cR
’ - [Option] Complete the current line from (the remaining) older history
entries (
mle-hist-srch-bwd
). - ‘
\cS
’ - [Option] Complete the current line from (the remaining) newer history
entries (
mle-hist-srch-fwd
). - ‘
\cT
’ - Paste the snarf buffer (
mle-paste
). - ‘
\cU
’ - The same as ‘
\cA
’ followed by ‘\cK
’ (mle-snarf-line
). - ‘
\cV
’ - Prompts for a Unicode character (hexadecimal number without prefix, see
vexpr
) to be inserted (mle-prompt-char
). Note this command needs to be assigned to a single-letter control code in order to become recognized and executed during input of a key-sequence (only three single-letter control codes can be used for that shortcut purpose); this control code is then special-treated and thus cannot be part of any other sequence (because it will trigger themle-prompt-char
function immediately). - ‘
\cW
’ - Cut the characters from the one preceding the cursor to the preceding word
boundary (
mle-snarf-word-bwd
). - ‘
\cX
’ - Move the cursor forward one word boundary
(
mle-go-word-fwd
). - ‘
\cY
’ - Move the cursor backward one word boundary
(
mle-go-word-bwd
). - ‘
\cZ
’ - raise(3)
‘
SIGTSTP
’ (mle-raise-tstp
). - ‘
\c[
’ - Escape: reset a possibly used multibyte character input state machine and
[Option]ally a lingering, incomplete key binding
(
mle-cancel
). This command needs to be assigned to a single-letter control code in order to become recognized and executed during input of a key-sequence (only three single-letter control codes can be used for that shortcut purpose). This control code may also be part of a multi-byte sequence, but if a sequence is active and the very control code is currently also an expected input, then the active sequence takes precedence and will consume the control code. - ‘
\c\
’ - ([Option]ally context-dependent) Invokes the command
‘
’.z
+ - ‘
\c]
’ - ([Option]ally context-dependent) Invokes the command
‘
’.z
$ - ‘
\c^
’ - ([Option]ally context-dependent) Invokes the command
‘
’.z
0 - ‘
\c_
’ - Cut the characters from the one after the cursor to the succeeding word
boundary (
mle-snarf-word-fwd
). - ‘
\c?
’ - Backspace:
mle-del-bwd
. - –
mle-bell
: ring the audible bell.- –
- [Option]
mle-clear-screen
: move the cursor home and clear the screen. - –
mle-fullreset
: different tomle-reset
this will immediately reset a possibly active search etc.- –
mle-go-screen-bwd
: move the cursor backward one screen width.- –
mle-go-screen-fwd
: move the cursor forward one screen width.- –
mle-raise-quit:
raise(3) ‘SIGQUIT
’.
Coloured display
[Option] Colours and font attributes through ANSI a.k.a. ISO 6429
SGR (select graphic rendition) escape sequences are optionally supported.
Usage of colours and font attributes solely depends upon the capability of
the detected terminal type (TERM
), and as fine-tuned
through termcap. Colours and font attributes can be
managed with the multiplexer command colour
, and
uncolour
removes the given mappings. Setting
colour-disable suppresses usage of colour and font
attribute sequences, while leaving established mappings unchanged.
Whether actually applicable colour and font attribute sequences
should also be generated when output is going to be paged through the
external PAGER
(also see crt)
depends upon the setting of colour-pager, because
pagers usually need to be configured in order to support ISO escape
sequences. Knowledge of some widely used pagers is however built-in, and in
a clean environment it is often enough to simply set
colour-pager; please refer to that variable for more
on this topic.
It might make sense to conditionalize colour setup on interactive
mode via if
(‘terminal
’ indeed means
“interactive”):
if terminal && "$features" =% ,+colour, colour iso view-msginfo ft=bold,fg=green colour iso view-header ft=bold,fg=red (from|subject) # regex colour iso view-header fg=red uncolour iso view-header from,subject colour iso view-header ft=bold,fg=magenta,bg=cyan colour 256 view-header ft=bold,fg=208,bg=230 "subject,from" colour mono view-header ft=bold colour mono view-header ft=bold,ft=reverse subject,from endif
Handling spam
[Option] Mail can make use of several spam interfaces for the
purpose of identification of, and, in general, dealing with spam messages. A
precondition of most commands in order to function is that the
spam-interface variable is set to one of the supported
interfaces. Specifying
messages that have been identified as spam is possible via their
(volatile) ‘is-spam
’ state by using
the ‘:s
’ and
‘:S
’
specifications, and their attrlist entries will be
used when displaying the headline in the summary of
headers
.
spamrate
rates the given messages and sets their ‘is-spam
’ flag accordingly. If the spam interface offers spam scores these can be shown in headline by using the format ‘%$
’.spamham
,spamspam
andspamforget
will interact with the Bayesian filter of the chosen interface and learn the given messages as “ham” or “spam”, respectively; the last command can be used to cause “unlearning” of messages; it adheres to their current ‘is-spam
’ state and thus reverts previous teachings.spamclear
andspamset
will simply set and clear, respectively, the mentioned volatile ‘is-spam
’ message flag, without any interface interaction.
The
spamassassin(1) based
spam-interface
‘spamc
’ requires a running instance of
the spamd(1) server in order to
function, started with the option --allow-tell
shall
Bayesian filter learning be possible.
$ spamd -i localhost:2142 -i /tmp/.spamsock -d [-L] [-l] $ spamd --listen=localhost:2142 --listen=/tmp/.spamsock \ --daemonize [--local] [--allow-tell]
Thereafter Mail can make use of these interfaces:
$ mail -Sspam-interface=spamc -Sspam-maxsize=500000 \ -Sspamc-command=/usr/local/bin/spamc \ -Sspamc-arguments="-U /tmp/.spamsock" -Sspamc-user= or $ mail -Sspam-interface=spamc -Sspam-maxsize=500000 \ -Sspamc-command=/usr/local/bin/spamc \ -Sspamc-arguments="-d localhost -p 2142" -Sspamc-user=
Using the generic filter approach allows usage of programs like
bogofilter(1). Here is an
example, requiring it to be accessible via PATH
:
$ mail -Sspam-interface=filter -Sspam-maxsize=500000 \ -Sspamfilter-ham="bogofilter -n" \ -Sspamfilter-noham="bogofilter -N" \ -Sspamfilter-nospam="bogofilter -S" \ -Sspamfilter-rate="bogofilter -TTu 2>/dev/null" \ -Sspamfilter-spam="bogofilter -s" \ -Sspamfilter-rate-scanscore="1;^(.+)$"
Because messages must exist on local storage in order to be scored (or used for Bayesian filter training), it is possibly a good idea to perform the local spam check last. Spam can be checked automatically when opening specific folders by setting a specialized form of the internal variable folder-hook.
define spamdelhook { # Server side DCC spamset (header x-dcc-brand-metrics "bulk") # Server-side spamassassin(1) spamset (header x-spam-flag "YES") del :s # TODO we HAVE to be able to do `spamrate :u ! :sS' move :S +maybe-spam spamrate :u del :s move :S +maybe-spam } set folder-hook-SOMEFOLDER=spamdelhook
See also the documentation for the variables spam-interface, spam-maxsize, spamc-command, spamc-arguments, spamc-user, spamfilter-ham, spamfilter-noham, spamfilter-nospam, spamfilter-rate and spamfilter-rate-scanscore.
COMMANDS
Mail reads input in lines. An unquoted reverse solidus
‘\
’ at the end of a command line
“escapes” the newline character: it is discarded and the next
line of input is used as a follow-up line, with all leading whitespace
removed; once an entire line is completed, the whitespace characters
space
, tabulator
,
newline
as well as those defined by the variable
ifs are removed from the beginning and end. Placing
any whitespace characters at the beginning of a line will prevent a possible
addition of the command line to the [Option]al
history
.
The beginning of such input lines is then scanned for the name of
a known command: command names may be abbreviated, in which case the first
command that matches the given prefix will be used.
Command modifiers may prefix a
command in order to modify its behaviour. A name may also be a
commandalias
, which will become expanded until no
more expansion is possible. Once the command that shall be executed is
known, the remains of the input line will be interpreted according to
command-specific rules, documented in the following.
This behaviour is different to the
sh(1)ell, which is a programming
language with syntactic elements of clearly defined semantics, and therefore
capable to sequentially expand and evaluate individual elements of a line.
‘? set one=value two=$one
’ for example
will never possibly assign value to one, because the variable assignment is
performed no sooner but by the command (set
), long
after the expansion happened.
A list of all commands in lookup order is dumped by the command
list
. [Option]ally the command
help
(or ?
), when given an
argument, will show a documentation string for the command matching the
expanded argument, as in ‘?t
’, which
should be a shorthand of ‘?type
’; with
these documentation strings both commands support a more
verbose listing mode which includes the argument type
of the command and other information which applies; a handy suggestion might
thus be:
? define __xv { # Before v15: need to enable sh(1)ell-style on _entire_ line! localopts yes;wysh set verbose;ignerr eval "${@}";return ${?} } ? commandalias xv '\call __xv' ? xv help set
Command modifiers
Commands may be prefixed by none to multiple command modifiers.
Some command modifiers can be used with a restricted set of commands only,
the verbose version of list
will ([Option]ally) show which modifiers apply.
- The modifier reverse solidus
\
, to be placed first, preventscommandalias
expansions on the remains of the line, for example ‘\echo
’ will always evaluate the commandecho
, even if an (command)alias of the same name exists.commandalias
content may itself contain further command modifiers, including an initial reverse solidus to prevent further expansions. - The modifier
ignerr
indicates that any error generated by the following command should be ignored by the state machine and not cause a program exit with enabled errexit or for the standardized exit cases in posix mode. ?, one of the INTERNAL VARIABLES, will be set to the real exit status of the command regardless. local
will alter the called command to apply changes only temporarily, local to block-scope, and can thus only be used inside of adefine
d macro or anaccount
definition. Specifying it implies the modifierwysh
. Local variables will not be inherited by macros deeper in thecall
chain, and all local settings will be garbage collected once the local scope is left. To record and unroll changes in the global scope use the commandlocalopts
.scope
does yet not implement any functionality.u
does yet not implement any functionality.- Some commands support the
vput
modifier: if used, they expect the name of a variable, which can itself be a variable, i.e., shell expansion is applied, as their first argument, and will place their computation result in it instead of the default location (it is usually written to standard output).The given name will be tested for being a valid sh(1) variable name, and may therefore only consist of upper- and lowercase characters, digits, and the underscore; the hyphen-minus may be used as a non-portable extension; digits may not be used as first, hyphen-minus may not be used as last characters. In addition the name may either not be one of the known INTERNAL VARIABLES, or must otherwise refer to a writable (non-boolean) value variable. The actual put operation may fail nonetheless, for example if the variable expects a number argument only a number will be accepted. Any error during these operations causes the command as such to fail, and the error number ! will be set to ^ERR-NOTSUP, the exit status ? should be set to ‘
-1
’, but some commands deviate from the latter, which is documented. - Last, but not least, the modifier
wysh
can be used for some old and established commands to choose the new Shell-style argument quoting rules over the traditional Old-style argument quoting. This modifier is implied if v15-compat is set to a non-empty value.
Old-style argument quoting
[v15 behaviour may differ] This section documents the traditional
and POSIX standardized style of quoting non-message list arguments to
commands which expect this type of arguments: whereas still used by the
majority of such commands, the new
Shell-style argument
quoting may be available even for those via
wysh
, one of the
Command modifiers. Nonetheless
care must be taken, because only new commands have been designed with all
the capabilities of the new quoting rules in mind, which can, for example
generate control characters.
- An argument can be enclosed between paired double-quotes
‘
"argument"
’ or single-quotes ‘'argument'
’; any whitespace, shell word expansion, or reverse solidus characters (except as described next) within the quotes are treated literally as part of the argument. A double-quote will be treated literally within single-quotes and vice versa. Inside such a quoted string the actually used quote character can be used nonetheless by escaping it with a reverse solidus ‘\
’, as in ‘"y\"ou"
’. - An argument that is not enclosed in quotes, as above, can usually still
contain space characters if those spaces are reverse solidus escaped, as
in ‘
you\ are
’. - A reverse solidus outside of the enclosing quotes is discarded and the following character is treated literally as part of the argument.
Shell-style argument quoting
sh(1)ell-style, and
therefore POSIX standardized, argument parsing and quoting rules are used by
most commands. [v15 behaviour may differ] Most new commands only support
these new rules and are flagged [Only new quoting rules], some elder ones
can use them with the command modifier wysh
; in the
future only this type of argument quoting will remain.
A command line is parsed from left to right and an input token is
completed whenever an unquoted, otherwise ignored, metacharacter is seen.
Metacharacters are vertical bar |
, ampersand
&
, semicolon ;
, as well
as all characters from the variable ifs, and / or
space
, tabulator
,
newline
. The additional metacharacters left and
right parenthesis (
, )
and
less-than and greater-than signs <
,
>
that the
sh(1) supports are not used, and are
treated as ordinary characters: for one these characters are a vivid part of
email addresses, and it seems highly unlikely that their function will
become meaningful to Mail.
It also often depends on an actual subcommand of a multiplexer
command how the rest of the line should be treated, and until v15 we are not
capable to perform this deep inspection of arguments. Nonetheless, at least
the following commands which work with positional parameters fully support
ifs for an almost shell-compatible field splitting:
call
, call_if
,
read
, vpospar
,
xcall
.
Any unquoted number sign ‘#
’
at the beginning of a new token starts a comment that extends to the end of
the line, and therefore ends argument processing. An unquoted dollar sign
‘$
’ will cause variable expansion of
the given name, which must be a valid
sh(1)ell-style variable name (see
vput
):
INTERNAL VARIABLES as well as
ENVIRONMENT (shell) variables can be
accessed through this mechanism, brace enclosing the name is supported
(i.e., to subdivide a token).
Whereas the metacharacters space
,
tabulator
, newline
only
complete an input token, vertical bar |
, ampersand
&
and semicolon ;
also
act as control operators and perform control functions. For now supported is
semicolon ;
, which terminates a single command,
therefore sequencing the command line and making the remainder of the line a
subject to reevaluation. With sequencing, multiple command argument types
and quoting rules may therefore apply to a single line, which can become
problematic before v15: e.g., the first of the following will cause
surprising results.
? echo one; set verbose; echo
verbose=$verbose.
? echo one; wysh set verbose; echo
verbose=$verbose.
Quoting is a mechanism that will remove the special meaning of metacharacters and reserved words, and will prevent expansion. There are four quoting mechanisms: the escape character, single-quotes, double-quotes and dollar-single-quotes:
- The literal value of any character can be preserved by preceding it with
the escape character reverse solidus
‘
\
’. - Arguments which are enclosed in
‘
'single-quotes'
’ retain their literal value. A single-quote cannot occur within single-quotes. - The literal value of all characters enclosed in
‘
"double-quotes"
’ is retained, with the exception of dollar sign ‘$
’, which will cause variable expansion, as above, backquote (grave accent) ‘`
’, (which not yet means anything special), reverse solidus ‘\
’, which will escape any of the characters dollar sign ‘$
’ (to prevent variable expansion), backquote (grave accent) ‘`
’, double-quote ‘"
’ (to prevent ending the quote) and reverse solidus ‘\
’ (to prevent escaping, i.e., to embed a reverse solidus character as-is), but has no special meaning otherwise. - Arguments enclosed in
‘
$'dollar-single-quotes'
’ extend normal single quotes in that reverse solidus escape sequences are expanded as follows:- ‘
\a
’ - bell control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 BEL).
- ‘
\b
’ - backspace control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 BS).
- ‘
\E
’ - escape control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 ESC).
- ‘
\e
’ - the same.
- ‘
\f
’ - form feed control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 FF).
- ‘
\n
’ - line feed control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 LF).
- ‘
\r
’ - carriage return control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 CR).
- ‘
\t
’ - horizontal tabulator control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 HT).
- ‘
\v
’ - vertical tabulator control character (ASCII and ISO-10646 VT).
- ‘
\\
’ - emits a reverse solidus character.
- ‘
\'
’ - single quote.
- ‘
\"
’ - double quote (escaping is optional).
- ‘
\NNN
’ - eight-bit byte with the octal value
‘
NNN
’ (one to three octal digits), optionally prefixed by an additional ‘0
’. A 0 byte will suppress further output for the quoted argument. - ‘
\xHH
’ - eight-bit byte with the hexadecimal value
‘
HH
’ (one or two hexadecimal characters, no prefix, seevexpr
). A 0 byte will suppress further output for the quoted argument. - ‘
\UHHHHHHHH
’ - the Unicode / ISO-10646 character with the hexadecimal codepoint value
‘
HHHHHHHH
’ (one to eight hexadecimal characters) — note that Unicode defines the maximum codepoint ever to be supported as ‘0x10FFFF
’ (in planes of ‘0xFFFF
’ characters each). This escape is only supported in locales that support Unicode (see Character sets), in other cases the sequence will remain unexpanded unless the given code point is ASCII compatible or (if the [Option]al character set conversion is available) can be represented in the current locale. The character NUL will suppress further output for the quoted argument. - ‘
\uHHHH
’ - Identical to ‘
\UHHHHHHHH
’ except it takes only one to four hexadecimal characters. - ‘
\cX
’ - Emits the non-printable (ASCII and compatible) C0 control codes 0
(NUL) to 31 (US), and 127 (DEL). Printable representations of ASCII
control codes can be created by mapping them to a different, visible
part of the ASCII character set. Adding the number 64 achieves this
for the codes 0 to 31, here 7 (BEL): ‘
7 + 64 = 71 = G
’. The real operation is a bitwise logical XOR with 64 (bit 7 set, seevexpr
), thus also covering code 127 (DEL), which is mapped to 63 (question mark): ‘? vexpr ^ 127 64
’.Whereas historically circumflex notation has often been used for visualization purposes of control codes, as in ‘
^G
’, the reverse solidus notation has been standardized: ‘\cG
’. Some control codes also have standardized (ISO-10646, ISO C) aliases, as shown above (‘\a
’, ‘\n
’, ‘\t
’ etc) : whenever such an alias exists it will be used for display purposes. The control code NUL (‘\c@
’, a non-standard extension) will suppress further output for the remains of the token (which may extend beyond the current quote), or, depending on the context, the remains of all arguments for the current command. - ‘
\$NAME
’ - Non-standard extension: expand the given variable name, as above. Brace enclosing the name is supported.
- ‘
\`{command}
’ - Not yet supported, just to raise awareness: Non-standard extension.
- ‘
Caveats:
? echo 'Quotes '${HOME}' and 'tokens" differ!"# no comment ? echo Quotes ${HOME} and tokens differ! # comment ? echo Don"'"t you worry$'\x21' The sun shines on us. $'\u263A'
Message list arguments
Many commands operate on message list specifications, as
documented in Specifying
messages. The argument input is first split into individual tokens via
Shell-style argument
quoting, which are then interpreted as the mentioned specifications. If
no explicit message list has been specified, many commands will search for
and use the next message forward that satisfies the commands' requirements,
and if there are no messages forward of the current message, the search
proceeds backwards; if there are no good messages at all to be found, an
error message is shown and the command is aborted. The
verbose output of the command
list
will indicate whether a command searches for a
default message, or not.
Raw data arguments for codec commands
A special set of commands, which all have the string
“codec” in their name, like addrcodec
,
shcodec
, urlcodec
, take raw
string data as input, which means that the content of the command input line
is passed completely unexpanded and otherwise unchanged: like this the
effect of the actual codec is visible without any noise of possible shell
quoting rules etc., i.e., the user can input one-to-one the desired or
questionable data. To gain a level of expansion, the entire command line can
be eval
uated first, for example
? vput shcodec res encode /usr/Schönes Wetter/heute.txt ? echo $res $'/usr/Sch\u00F6nes Wetter/heute.txt' ? shcodec d $res $'/usr/Sch\u00F6nes Wetter/heute.txt' ? eval shcodec d $res /usr/Schönes Wetter/heute.txt
Filename transformations
Filenames, where expected, and unless documented otherwise, are subsequently subject to the following filename transformations, in sequence:
- If the given name is a registered
shortcut
, it will be replaced with the expanded shortcut. This step is mostly taken forfolder
s only. - The filename is matched against the following patterns or strings. But for
plus +file folder expansion
this step is mostly taken for
folder
s only.- #
- (Number sign) is expanded to the previous file.
- %
- (Percent sign) is replaced by the invoking user's primary system
mailbox, which either is the (itself expandable)
inbox if that is set, the standardized absolute
pathname indicated by
MAIL
if that is set, or a built-in compile-time default otherwise. When opening afolder
the used name is actively checked for being a primary mailbox, first against inbox, then againstMAIL
. - %user
- Expands to the primary system mailbox of user (and never the value of inbox, regardless of its actual setting).
- &
- (Ampersand) is replaced with the invoking user's secondary mailbox,
the
MBOX
. - +file
- Refers to a file in the folder directory (if that variable is set).
- %:filespec
- Expands to the same value as filespec, but has
special meaning when used with, for example, the command
folder
: the file will be treated as a primary system mailbox by, among others, thembox
andsave
commands, meaning that messages that have been read in the current session will be moved to theMBOX
mailbox instead of simply being flagged as read.
- Meta expansions may be applied to the resulting filename, as allowed by
the operation and applicable to the resulting access protocol (also see
On URL syntax
and credential lookup). For the file-protocol, a leading tilde
‘
~
’ character will be replaced by the expansion ofHOME
, except when followed by a valid user name, in which case the home directory of the given user is used instead.A shell expansion as if specified in double-quotes (see Shell-style argument quoting) may be applied, so that any occurrence of ‘
$VARIABLE
’ (or ‘${VARIABLE}
’) will be replaced by the expansion of the variable, if possible; INTERNAL VARIABLES as well as ENVIRONMENT (shell) variables can be accessed through this mechanism.Shell pathname wildcard pattern expansions (glob(7)) may be applied as documented. If the fully expanded filename results in multiple pathnames and the command is expecting only one file, an error results.
In interactive context, in order to allow simple value acceptance (via “ENTER”), arguments will usually be displayed in a properly quoted form, so a file ‘
diet\ is \curd.txt
’ may be displayed as ‘'diet\ is \curd.txt'
’.
Commands
The following commands are available:
!
- Executes the
SHELL
command which follows, replacing unescaped exclamation marks with the previously executed command if the internal variable bang is set. This command supportsvput
as documented in Command modifiers, and manages the error number !. A 0 or positive exit status ? reflects the exit status of the command, negative ones that an error happened before the command was executed, or that the program did not exit cleanly, but maybe due to a signal: the error number is ^ERR-CHILD, then.In conjunction with the
vput
modifier the following special cases exist: a negative exit status occurs if the collected data could not be stored in the given variable, which is a ^ERR-NOTSUP error that should otherwise not occur. ^ERR-CANCELED indicates that no temporary file could be created to collect the command output at first glance. In case of catchable out-of-memory situations ^ERR-NOMEM will occur and Mail will try to store the empty string, just like with all other detected error conditions. #
- The comment-command causes the entire line to be ignored. Note: this really is a normal command which' purpose is to discard its arguments, not a “comment-start” indicating special character, which means that for example trailing comments on a line are not possible (except for commands which use Shell-style argument quoting).
+
- Goes to the next message in sequence and types it (like “ENTER”).
-
- Display the preceding message, or the n'th previous message if given a numeric argument n.
=
- Shows the message number of the current message (the “dot”)
when used without arguments, that of the given list otherwise. Output
numbers will be separated from each other with the first character of
ifs, and followed by the first character of
if-ws, if that is not empty and not identical to the
first. If that results in no separation at all a
space
character is used. This command supportsvput
(see Command modifiers), and manages the error number !. ?
- [Option] Show a brief summary of commands. [Option] Given an argument a
synopsis for the command in question is shown instead; commands can be
abbreviated in general and this command can be used to see the full
expansion of an abbreviation including the synopsis, try, for example
‘
?h
’, ‘?hel
’ and ‘?help
’ and see how the output changes. To avoid that aliases are resolved the modifier\
can be prepended to the argument, but note it must be quoted. This mode also supports a more verbose output, which will provide the information documented forlist
. |
- A synonym for the
pipe
command. account
,unaccount
- (ac, una) Creates, selects or lists (an) account(s). Accounts are special
incarnations of
define
d macros and group commands and variable settings which together usually arrange the environment for the purpose of creating an email account. Different to normal macros settings which are covered bylocalopts
– here by default enabled! – will not be reverted before theaccount
is changed again. The special account ‘null
’ (case-insensitive) always exists, and all but it can be deleted by the latter command, and in one operation with the special name ‘*
’. Also for all but it a possibly set on-account-cleanup hook is called once they are left, also for program exit.Without arguments a listing of all defined accounts is shown. With one argument the given account is activated: the system inbox of that account will be activated (as via
folder
), a possibly installed folder-hook will be run, and the internal variable account will be updated. The two argument form behaves identical to defining a macro as viadefine
. Important settings for accounts include folder, from, hostname, inbox, mta, password and user (On URL syntax and credential lookup), as well as things like tls-config-pairs (Encrypted network communication), and protocol specifics like imap-auth, pop3-auth, smtp-auth.account myisp { set folder=~/mail inbox=+syste.mbox record=+sent.mbox set from='(My Name) myname@myisp.example' set mta=smtp://mylogin@smtp.myisp.example }
addrcodec
- Perform email address codec transformations on raw-data argument, rather
according to email standards (RFC 5322; [v15 behaviour may differ] will
furtherly improve). Supports
vput
(see Command modifiers), and manages the error number !. The first argument must be either [+[+[+]]]e[ncode], d[ecode], s[kin] or skinl[ist] and specifies the operation to perform on the rest of the line.Decoding will show how a standard-compliant MUA will display the given argument, which should be an email address. Please be aware that most MUAs have difficulties with the address standards, and vary wildly when (comments) in parenthesis, “double-quoted” strings, or quoted-pairs, as below, become involved. [v15 behaviour may differ] Mail currently does not perform decoding when displaying addresses.
Skinning is identical to decoding but only outputs the plain address, without any string, comment etc. components. Another difference is that it may fail with the error number ! set to ^ERR-INVAL if decoding fails to find a(n) (valid) email address, in which case the unmodified input will be output again.
skinlist first performs a skin operation, and thereafter checks a valid address for whether it is a registered mailing list (see
mlist
andmlsubscribe
), eventually reporting that state in the error number ! as ^ERR-EXIST. (This state could later become overwritten by an I/O error, though.)Encoding supports four different modes, lesser automated versions can be chosen by prefixing one, two or three plus signs: the standard imposes a special meaning on some characters, which thus have to be transformed to so-called quoted-pairs by pairing them with a reverse solidus ‘
\
’ in order to remove the special meaning; this might change interpretation of the entire argument from what has been desired, however! Specify one plus sign to remark that parenthesis shall be left alone, two for not turning double quotation marks into quoted-pairs, and three for also leaving any user-specified reverse solidus alone. The result will always be valid, if a successful exit status is reported ([v15 behaviour may differ] the current parser fails this assertion for some constructs). [v15 behaviour may differ] Addresses need to be specified in between angle brackets ‘<
’, ‘>
’ if the construct becomes more difficult, otherwise the current parser will fail; it is not smart enough to guess right.? addrc enc "Hey, you",<diet@exam.ple>\ out\ there "\"Hey, you\", \\ out\\ there" <diet@exam.ple> ? addrc d "\"Hey, you\", \\ out\\ there" <diet@exam.ple> "Hey, you", \ out\ there <diet@exam.ple> ? addrc s "\"Hey, you\", \\ out\\ there" <diet@exam.ple> diet@exam.ple
alias
,unalias
- [Only new quoting rules](a, una) Define or list, and remove, respectively,
address aliases, which are a method of creating personal distribution
lists that map a single name to none to multiple receivers, to be expanded
after Compose mode is left; the
expansion correlates with metoo. The latter command
removes all given aliases, the special name asterisk
‘
*
’ will remove all existing aliases. When used without arguments the former shows a list of all currently known aliases, with one argument only the target(s) of the given one. When given two arguments, hyphen-minus ‘-
’ being the first, the target(s) of the second is/are expanded recursively.In all other cases the given alias is newly defined, or will be appended to: arguments must either be themselves valid alias names, or any other address type (see On sending mail, and non-interactive mode). Recursive expansion of aliases can be prevented by prefixing the desired argument with the modifier reverse solidus
\
. A valid alias name conforms to mta-aliases syntax, but follow-up characters can also be the number sign ‘#
’, colon ‘:
’, commercial at ‘@,
’ exclamation mark ‘!
’, period ‘.
’ as well as “any character that has the high bit set”. The dollar sign ‘$
’ may be the last character. The number sign ‘#
’ may need Shell-style argument quoting.[v15 behaviour may differ] Unfortunately the colon is currently not supported, as it interferes with normal address parsing rules. [v15 behaviour may differ] Such high bit characters will likely cause warnings at the moment for the same reasons why colon is unsupported; also, in the future locale dependent character set validity checks will be performed.
? alias cohorts bill jkf mark kridle@ucbcory ~/cohorts.mbox ? alias mark mark@exam.ple ? set mta-aliases=/etc/aliases
alternates
,unalternates
- [Only new quoting rules] (alt) Manage a list of alternate addresses or
names of the active user, members of which will be removed from recipient
lists (except one). There is a set of implicit alternates which is formed
of the values of
LOGNAME
, from, sender and reply-to. from will not be used if sender is set. The latter command removes the given list of alternates, the special name ‘*
’ will discard all existing alternate names.The former command manages the error number !. It shows the current set of alternates when used without arguments; in this mode only it also supports
vput
(see Command modifiers). Otherwise the given arguments (after being checked for validity) are appended to the list of alternate names; in posix mode they replace that list instead. answered
,unanswered
- Take a message lists and mark each message as (not) having been answered.
Messages will be marked answered when being
reply
d to automatically if the markanswered variable is set. See the section Message states. bind
,unbind
- [Option][Only new quoting rules] The bind command extends the MLE (see
On terminal
control and line editor) with freely configurable key bindings. The
latter command removes from the given context the given key binding, both
of which may be specified as a wildcard
‘
*
’, so that ‘unbind * *
’ will remove all bindings of all contexts. Due to initialization order unbinding will not work for built-in key bindings upon program startup, however: please use line-editor-no-defaults for this purpose instead.With zero arguments, or with a context name the former command shows all key bindings (of the given context; an asterisk ‘
*
’ will iterate over all contexts); a more verbose listing will be produced if either of debug or verbose are set. With two or more arguments a specific binding is shown, or (re)established: the first argument is the context to which the binding shall apply, the second argument is a comma-separated list of the “keys” which form the binding. Further arguments will be joined to form the expansion, and cause the binding to be created or updated. To indicate that a binding shall not be auto-committed, but that the expansion shall instead be furtherly editable by the user, a commercial at ‘@
’ (that will be removed) can be placed last in the expansion, from which leading and trailing whitespace will finally be removed. Reverse solidus cannot be used as the last character of expansion. An empty expansion will be rejected.Contexts define when a binding applies, i.e., a binding will not be seen unless the context for which it is defined for is currently active. This is not true for the shared binding ‘
base
’, which is the foundation for all other bindings and as such always applies, its bindings, however, only apply secondarily. The available contexts are the shared ‘base
’, the ‘default
’ context which is used in all not otherwise documented situations, and ‘compose
’, which applies only to Compose mode.Bindings are specified as a comma-separated list of byte-sequences, where each list entry corresponds to one “key” (press). Byte sequence boundaries will be forcefully terminated after bind-inter-byte-timeout milliseconds, whereas key sequences can be timed out via bind-inter-key-timeout. A list entry may, indicated by a leading colon character ‘
:
’, also refer to the name of a terminal capability; several dozen names are compiled in and may be specified either by their terminfo(5), or, if existing, by their termcap(5) name, regardless of the actually used [Option]al terminal control library. But any capability may be used, as long as the name is resolvable by the [Option]al control library, or was defined via the internal variable termcap. Input sequences are not case-normalized, an exact match is required to update or remove a binding. It is advisable to use an initial escape or other control character (like ‘\cA
’) for user (as opposed to purely terminal capability based) bindings in order to avoid ambiguities; it also reduces search time. Examples:? bind base a,b echo one ? bind base $'\E',d mle-snarf-word-fwd # Esc(ape) ? bind base $'\E',$'\c?' mle-snarf-word-bwd # Esc,Delete ? bind default $'\cA',:khome,w 'echo Editable binding@' ? bind default a,b,c rm -irf / @ # Also editable ? bind default :kf1 File % ? bind compose :kf1 ~v
Note that the entire comma-separated list is first parsed (over) as a shell-token with whitespace as the field separator, then parsed and expanded for real with comma as the field separator, therefore whitespace needs to be properly quoted, see Shell-style argument quoting. Using Unicode reverse solidus escape sequences renders a binding defunctional if the locale does not support Unicode (see Character sets), and using terminal capabilities does so if no (corresponding) terminal control support is (currently) available. Adding, deleting or modifying a key binding invalidates the internal prebuilt lookup tree, it will be recreated as necessary: this process will be visualized in most verbose as well as in debug mode.
The following terminal capability names are built-in and can be used in terminfo(5) or (if available) the two-letter termcap(5) notation. See the respective manual for a list of capabilities. The program infocmp(1) can be used to show all the capabilities of
TERM
or the given terminal type; using the-x
flag will also show supported (non-standard) extensions.kbs
orkb
- Backspace.
kdch1
orkD
- Delete character.
kDC
or*4
- — shifted variant.
kel
orkE
- Clear to end of line.
kext
or@9
- Exit.
kich1
orkI
- Insert character.
kIC
or#3
- — shifted variant.
khome
orkh
- Home.
kHOM
or#2
- — shifted variant.
kend
or@7
- End.
knp
orkN
- Next page.
kpp
orkP
- Previous page.
kcub1
orkl
- Left cursor (with more modifiers: see below).
kLFT
or#4
- — shifted variant.
kcuf1
orkr
- Right cursor (ditto).
kRIT
or%i
- — shifted variant.
kcud1
orkd
- Down cursor (ditto).
kDN
- — shifted variant (only terminfo).
kcuu1
orku
- Up cursor (ditto).
kUP
- — shifted variant (only terminfo).
kf0
ork0
- Function key 0. Add one for each function key up to
kf9
andk9
, respectively. kf10
ork;
- Function key 10.
kf11
orF1
- Function key 11. Add one for each function key up to
kf19
andF9
, respectively.
Some terminals support key-modifier combination extensions, e.g., ‘
Alt+Shift+xy
’. For example, the delete key,kdch1
: in its shifted variant, the name is mutated tokDC
, then a number is appended for the states ‘Alt
’ (kDC3
), ‘Shift+Alt
’ (kDC4
), ‘Control
’ (kDC5
), ‘Shift+Control
’ (kDC6
), ‘Alt+Control
’ (kDC7
), finally ‘Shift+Alt+Control
’ (kDC8
). The same for the left cursor key,kcub1
:KLFT
,KLFT3
,KLFT4
,KLFT5
,KLFT6
,KLFT7
,KLFT8
. call
- [Only new quoting rules] Calls the given macro, which must have been
created via
define
(see there for more), otherwise an ^ERR-NOENT error occurs. Calling macros recursively will at some time excess the stack size limit, causing a hard program abortion; if recursively calling a macro is the last command of the current macro, consider to use the commandxcall
, which will first release all resources of the current macro before replacing the current macro with the called one. call_if
- Identical to
call
if the given macro has been created viadefine
, but does not fail nor warn if the macro does not exist. cd
- Synonym for
chdir
. certsave
- [Option] Only applicable to S/MIME signed messages. Takes an optional message list and a filename and saves the certificates contained within the message signatures to the named file in both human-readable and PEM format. The certificates can later be used to send encrypted messages to the respective message senders by setting smime-encrypt-USER@HOST variables.
charsetalias
,uncharsetalias
- [Only new quoting rules] Manage alias mappings for (conversion of)
Character sets. Alias processing
is not performed for INTERNAL
VARIABLES, for example charset-8bit, and
mappings are ineffective if character set conversion is not available
(features does not announce
‘
,+iconv,
’). Expansion happens recursively for cases where aliases point to other aliases (built-in loop limit: 8).The latter command deletes all aliases given as arguments, or all at once when given the asterisk ‘
*
’. The former shows the list of all currently defined aliases if used without arguments, or the target of the given single argument; when given two arguments, hyphen-minus ‘-
’ being the first, the second is instead expanded recursively. In all other cases the given arguments are treated as pairs of character sets and their desired target alias name, creating new or updating already existing aliases. chdir
- [Only new quoting rules](ch) Change the working directory to
HOME
or the given argument. Synonym forcd
. collapse
,uncollapse
- Only applicable to ‘
thread
’edsort
mode. Takes a message list and makes all replies to these messages invisible in header summaries, except for ‘new
’ messages and the “dot”. Also when a message with collapsed replies is displayed, all of these are automatically uncollapsed. The latter command undoes collapsing. colour
,uncolour
- [Option][Only new quoting rules] Manage colour mappings of and for a
Coloured display. Without
arguments the former shows all currently defined mappings. Otherwise a
colour type is expected (case-insensitively), it must be one of
‘
256
’ for 256-colour terminals, ‘8
’, ‘ansi
’ or ‘iso
’ for the standard 8-colour ANSI / ISO 6429 colour palette, and ‘1
’ or ‘mono
’ for monochrome terminals, which only support (some) font attributes. Without further arguments the list of all currently defined mappings of the given type is shown (here the special ‘all
’ or ‘*
’ also show all currently defined mappings).Otherwise the second argument defines the mappable slot, the third argument a (comma-separated list of) colour and font attribute specification(s), and the optionally supported fourth argument can be used to specify a precondition: if conditioned mappings exist they are tested in (creation) order unless a (case-insensitive) match has been found, and the default mapping (if any has been established) will only be chosen as a last resort. The types of available preconditions depend on the mappable slot, the following of which exist:
Mappings prefixed with ‘
mle-
’ are used for the [Option]al built-in Mailx-Line-Editor (MLE, see On terminal control and line editor) and do not support preconditions.- mle-position
- This mapping is used for the position indicator that is visible when a line cannot be fully displayed on the screen.
- mle-prompt
- Used for the prompt.
- mle-error
- Used for the occasionally appearing error indicator that is joined onto prompt. [v15 behaviour may differ] Also used for error messages written on standard error .
Mappings prefixed with ‘
sum-
’ are used in header summaries, and they all understand the preconditions ‘dot
’ (the current message) and ‘older
’ for elder messages (only honoured in conjunction with datefield-markout-older).- sum-dotmark
- This mapping is used for the “dotmark” that can be
created with the ‘
%>
’ or ‘%<
’ formats of the variable headline. - sum-header
- For the complete header summary line except the “dotmark” and the thread structure.
- sum-thread
- For the thread structure which can be created with the
‘
%i
’ format of the variable headline.
Mappings prefixed with ‘
view-
’ are used when displaying messages.- view-from_
- This mapping is used for so-called
‘
From_
’ lines, which are MBOX file format specific header lines (also see mbox-rfc4155). - view-header
- For header lines. A comma-separated list of headers to which the mapping applies may be given as a precondition; if the [Option]al regular expression support is available then if any of the magic regular expression characters is seen the precondition will be evaluated as (an extended) one.
- view-msginfo
- For the introductional message info line.
- view-partinfo
- For MIME part info lines.
The following (case-insensitive) colour definitions and font attributes are understood, multiple of which can be specified in a comma-separated list:
- ft=
- a font attribute: ‘
bold
’, ‘reverse
’ or ‘underline
’. It is possible (and often applicable) to specify multiple font attributes for a single mapping. - fg=
- foreground colour attribute, in order (numbers 0 - 7)
‘
black
’, ‘red
’, ‘green
’, ‘brown
’, ‘blue
’, ‘magenta
’, ‘cyan
’ or ‘white
’. To specify a 256-colour mode a decimal number colour specification in the range 0 to 255, inclusive, is supported, and interpreted as follows:- 0 - 7
- the standard ISO 6429 colours, as above.
- 8 - 15
- high intensity variants of the standard colours.
- 16 - 231
- 216 colours in tuples of 6.
- 232 - 255
- grayscale from black to white in 24 steps.
#!/bin/sh - fg() { printf "\033[38;5;${1}m($1)"; } bg() { printf "\033[48;5;${1}m($1)"; } i=0 while [ $i -lt 256 ]; do fg $i; i=$(($i + 1)); done printf "\033[0m\n" i=0 while [ $i -lt 256 ]; do bg $i; i=$(($i + 1)); done printf "\033[0m\n"
- bg=
- background colour attribute (see
fg=
for possible values).
The command
uncolour
will remove for the given colour type (the special type ‘*
’ selects all) the given mapping; if the optional precondition argument is given only the exact tuple of mapping and precondition is removed. The special name ‘*
’ will remove all mappings (no precondition allowed), thus ‘uncolour * *
’ will remove all established mappings. commandalias
,uncommandalias
- [Only new quoting rules] Define or list, and remove, respectively, command
aliases. An (command)alias can be used everywhere a normal command can be
used, but always takes precedence: any arguments that are given to the
command alias are joined onto the alias expansion, and the resulting
string forms the command line that is, in effect, executed. The latter
command removes all given aliases, the special name asterisk
‘
*
’ will remove all existing aliases. When used without arguments the former shows a list of all currently known aliases, with one argument only the expansion of the given one.With two or more arguments a command alias is defined or updated: the first argument is the name under which the remaining command line should be accessible, the content of which can be just about anything. An alias may itself expand to another alias, but to avoid expansion loops further expansion will be prevented if an alias refers to itself or if an expansion depth limit is reached. Explicit expansion prevention is available via reverse solidus
\
, one of the Command modifiers.? commandalias xx mail: `commandalias': no such alias: xx ? commandalias xx echo hello, ? commandalias xx commandalias xx 'echo hello,' ? xx hello, ? xx world hello, world
Copy
- (C) Similar to
copy
, but copy the messages to a file named after the local part of the sender of the first message instead of taking a filename argument; outfolder is inspected to decide on the actual storage location. copy
- (c) Copy messages to the named file and do not mark them as being saved;
otherwise identical to
save
. csop
- [Only new quoting rules] A multiplexer command which provides C-style
string operations on 8-bit bytes without a notion of locale settings and
character sets, effectively assuming ASCII data. For numeric and other
operations refer to
vexpr
.vput
, one of the Command modifiers, is supported. The error result is ‘-1
’ for usage errors and numeric results, the empty string otherwise; missing data errors, as for unsuccessful searches, result in the ! error number being set to ^ERR-NODATA. Where the question mark ‘?
’ modifier suffix is supported, a case-insensitive (ASCII mapping) operation mode is supported; the keyword ‘case
’ is optional so that ‘find?
’ and ‘find?case
’ are identical.length
- Queries the length of the given argument.
hash
,hash32
- Calculates a hash value of the given argument. The latter will return
a 32-bit result regardless of host environment.
‘
?
’ modifier suffix is supported. These use Chris Torek's hash algorithm, the resulting hash value is bit mixed as shown by Bret Mulvey. find
- Search for the second in the first argument. Shows the resulting
0-based offset shall it have been found.
‘
?
’ modifier suffix is supported. substring
- Creates a substring of its first argument. The optional second argument is the 0-based starting offset, a negative one counts from the end; the optional third argument specifies the length of the desired result, a negative length leaves off the given number of bytes at the end of the original string; by default the entire string is used. This operation tries to work around faulty arguments (set verbose for error logs), but reports them via the error number ! as ^ERR-OVERFLOW.
trim
- Trim away whitespace characters from both ends of the argument.
trim-front
- Trim away whitespace characters from the begin of the argument.
trim-end
- Trim away whitespace characters from the end of the argument.
cwd
- Show the name of the current working directory, as reported by
getcwd(3). Supports
vput
(see Command modifiers). The return status is tracked via ?. Decrypt
- [Option] For unencrypted messages this command is identical to
Copy
; Encrypted messages are first decrypted, if possible, and then copied. decrypt
- [Option] For unencrypted messages this command is identical to
copy
; Encrypted messages are first decrypted, if possible, and then copied. define
,undefine
- The latter command deletes the given macro, the special name
‘
*
’ will discard all existing macros. Deletion of (a) macro(s) can be performed from within running (a) macro(s), including self-deletion. Without arguments the former command prints the current list of macros, including their content, otherwise it defines a macro, replacing an existing one of the same name as applicable.A defined macro can be invoked explicitly by using the
call
,call_if
andxcall
commands, or implicitly if a macro hook is triggered, for example a folder-hook. Execution of a macro body can be stopped from within by callingreturn
.Temporary macro block-scope variables can be created or deleted with the
local
command modifier in conjunction with the commandsset
andunset
, respectively. To enforce unrolling of changes made to (global) INTERNAL VARIABLES the commandlocalopts
can be used instead; its covered scope depends on how (i.e., “as what”: normal macro, folder hook, hook,account
switch) the macro is invoked.Inside a
call
ed macro, the given positional parameters are implicitly local to the macro's scope, and may be accessed via the variables *, @, # and 1 and any other positive unsigned decimal number less than or equal to #. Positional parameters can beshift
ed, or become completely replaced, removed etc. viavpospar
. A helpful command for numeric computation and string evaluations isvexpr
,csop
offers C-style byte string operations.define name { command1 command2 ... commandN } define exmac { echo Parameter 1 of ${#} is ${1}, all: ${*} / ${@} return 1000 0 } call exmac Hello macro exmac! echo ${?}/${!}/${^ERRNAME}
delete
,undelete
- (d, u) Marks the given message list as being or not being
‘
deleted
’, respectively; if no argument has been specified then the usual search for a visible message is performed, as documented for Message list arguments, showing only the next input prompt if the search fails. Deleted messages will neither be saved in the secondary mailboxMBOX
nor will they be available for most other commands. If the autoprint variable is set, the new “dot” or the last message restored, respectively, is automaticallytype
d; also seedp
,dt
. digmsg
- [Only new quoting rules] Digging (information out of) messages is possible
through
digmsg
objects, which can becreate
d for the given message number; in Compose mode the hyphen-minus ‘-
’ will instead open the message that is being composed. If a hyphen-minus is given as the optional third argument then output will be generated on the standard output channel instead of being subject to consumption by thereadall
(orread
andreadsh
) command(s). Note: output must be consumed before normal processing can continue; fordigmsg
objects this means each command output has to be read until the end of file (EOF) state occurs.The objects may be
remove
d again by giving the same identifier used for creation; this step could be omitted: objects will be automatically closed when the activefolder
(mailbox) or the compose mode is left, respectively. In all other use cases the second argument is an object identifier, and the third and all following arguments are interpreted as via~^
(see COMMAND ESCAPES):? vput = msgno; digmsg create $msgno ? digmsg $msgno header list; readall x; echon $x 210 Subject From To Message-ID References In-Reply-To ? digmsg $msgno header show Subject;readall x;echon $x 212 Subject 'Hello, world' ? digmsg remove $msgno
discard
- (di) Identical to
ignore
. Superseded by the multiplexerheaderpick
. dp
,dt
- Delete the given messages and automatically
type
the new “dot” if one exists, regardless of the setting of autoprint. dotmove
- Move the “dot” up or down by one message when given
‘
+
’ or ‘-
’ argument, respectively. draft
,undraft
- Take message lists and mark each given message as being draft, or not being draft, respectively, as documented in the section Message states.
echo
- [Only new quoting rules](ec) Print the given strings, equivalent to the
shell utility echo(1), that is,
Shell-style argument
quoting expansion is performed and, different to the otherwise
identical
echon
, a trailing newline is echoed.vput
as documented in Command modifiers is supported, and the error number ! is managed: if data is stored in a variable then the return value reflects the length of the result string in case of success and is ‘-1
’ on error.Remarks: this command traditionally (in BSD Mail) also performed Filename transformations, which is standard incompatible and hard to handle because quoting transformation patterns is not possible; the subcommand
file-expand
ofvexpr
can be used to expand filenames. echoerr
- [Only new quoting rules] Identical to
echo
, but the message is written to standard error, and prefixed by log-prefix. Also seeechoerrn
. In interactive sessions the [Option]al message ring queue forerrors
will be used instead, if available andvput
was not used. echon
- [Only new quoting rules] Identical to
echo
, but does not write or store a trailing newline. echoerrn
- [Only new quoting rules] Identical to
echoerr
, but does not write or store a trailing newline. edit
- (e) Point the text
EDITOR
at each message from the given list in turn. Modified contents are discarded unless the writebackedited variable is set, and are not used unless the mailbox can be written to and the editor returns a successful exit status.visual
can be used instead for a more display oriented editor. elif
- Part of the
if
(see there for more),elif
,else
,endif
conditional — if the condition of a precedingif
was false, check the following condition and execute the following block if it evaluates true. else
- (el) Part of the
if
(see there for more),elif
,else
,endif
conditional — if none of the conditions of the precedingif
andelif
commands was true, theelse
block is executed. endif
- (en) Marks the end of an
if
(see there for more),elif
,else
,endif
conditional execution block. environ
- [Only new quoting rules] There is a strict separation in between
INTERNAL VARIABLES and the
program ENVIRONMENT, which is
inherited by child processes. Some variables of the latter are however
vivid for program operation, their purpose is known, therefore they have
been integrated transparently into handling of the former, as accessible
via
set
andunset
. To integrate any other environment variable, and/or to export internal variables into the process environment where they normally are not, alink
needs to become established with this command, for exampleenviron link PERL5LIB TZ
Afterwards changing such variables with
set
will cause automatic updates of the environment, too. Sufficient system support provided (it was in BSD as early as 1987, and is standardized since Y2K) removing such variables withunset
will remove them also from the environment, but in any way the knowledge they ever have beenlink
ed will be lost. This implies thatlocalopts
may cause loss of such links.The subcommand
unlink
removes an existing link without otherwise touching variables, theset
andunset
subcommands are identical toset
andunset
, but additionally update the program environment accordingly; removing a variable breaks any freely establishedlink
. errors
- [Option] As console user interfaces at times scroll error messages by too fast and/or out of scope, data can additionally be sent to an error queue manageable by this command: show or no argument will display and clear the queue, clear will only clear it. As the queue becomes filled with errors-limit entries the eldest entries are being dropped. There are also the variables ^ERRQUEUE-COUNT and ^ERRQUEUE-EXISTS.
eval
- [Only new quoting rules] Construct a command by concatenating the
arguments, separated with a single space character, and then evaluate the
result. This command passes through the exit status
? and error number ! of the
evaluated command; also see
call
.define xxx { echo "xxx arg <$1>" shift if $# -gt 0 \xcall xxx "$@" endif } define yyy { eval "$@ ' ball" } call yyy '\call xxx' "b\$'\t'u ' " call xxx arg <b u> call xxx arg < > call xxx arg <ball>
exit
- (ex or x) Exit from Mail without changing the active mailbox and skip any
saving of messages in the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
, as well as a possibly tracked line editor history-file. A possibly set on-account-cleanup will be invoked, however. The optional status number argument will be passed through to exit(3). [v15 behaviour may differ] For now it can happen that the given status will be overwritten, later this will only occur if a later error needs to be reported onto an otherwise success indicating status. File
- (Fi) Like
folder
, but open the mailbox read-only. file
- (fi) See
folder
. filetype
,unfiletype
- [Only new quoting rules] Define, list, and remove, respectively, file
handler hooks, which provide (shell) commands that enable Mail to load and
save MBOX files from and to files with the registered file extensions, as
shown and described for
folder
. The extensions are used case-insensitively, yet the auto-completion feature of for examplefolder
will only work case-sensitively. An intermediate temporary file will be used to store the expanded data. The latter command will remove hooks for all given extensions, asterisk ‘*
’ will remove all existing handlers.When used without arguments the former shows a list of all currently defined file hooks, with one argument the expansion of the given alias. Otherwise three arguments are expected, the first specifying the file extension for which the hook is meant, and the second and third defining the load- and save commands to deal with the file type, respectively, both of which must read from standard input and write to standard output. Changing hooks will not affect already opened mailboxes ([v15 behaviour may differ] except below). [v15 behaviour may differ] For now too much work is done, and files are oftened read in twice where once would be sufficient: this can cause problems if a filetype is changed while such a file is opened; this was already so with the built-in support of .gz etc. in Heirloom, and will vanish in v15. [v15 behaviour may differ] For now all handler strings are passed to the
SHELL for evaluation purposes; in the future a
‘!
’ prefix to load and save commands may mean to bypass this shell instance: placing a leading space will avoid any possible misinterpretations.? filetype bz2 'bzip2 -dc' 'bzip2 -zc' \ gz 'gzip -dc' 'gzip -c' xz 'xz -dc' 'xz -zc' \ zst 'zstd -dc' 'zstd -19 -zc' \ zst.pgp 'gpg -d | zstd -dc' 'zstd -19 -zc | gpg -e' ? set record=+sent.zst.pgp
flag
,unflag
- Take message lists and mark the messages as being flagged, or not being flagged, respectively, for urgent/special attention. See the section Message states.
Folder
- (Fold) Like
folder
, but open the mailbox read-only. folder
- (fold) Open a new, or show status information of the current mailbox. If
an argument is given, changes (such as deletions) will be written out, a
new mailbox will be opened, the internal variables
mailbox-resolved and
mailbox-display will be updated, a set according
folder-hook is executed, and optionally a summary of
headers
is displayed if the variable header is set.Filename transformations will be applied to the name argument, and ‘
protocol://
’ prefixes are, i.e., URL (see On URL syntax and credential lookup) syntax is understood, as in ‘mbox:///tmp/somefolder
’. If a protocol prefix is used the mailbox type is fixated, otherwise opening none-existingfolders
uses the protocol defined in newfolders.For the protocols mbox and file (MBOX database), as well as eml (electronic mail message [v15 behaviour may differ] read-only) the list of all registered
filetype
s is traversed to check whether hooks shall be used to load (and save) data from (and to) the given name. Changing hooks will not affect already opened mailboxes. For example, the following creates hooks for the gzip(1) compression tool and a combined compressed and encrypted format:? filetype \ gzip 'gzip -dc' 'gzip -c' \ zst.pgp 'gpg -d | zstd -dc' 'zstd -19 -zc | gpg -e'
For historic reasons
filetype
s provide limited (case-sensitive) auto-completion capabilities. For example ‘mbox.gz
’ will be found for ‘? file mbox
’, provided that corresponding handlers are installed. It will neither find ‘mbox.GZ
’ nor ‘mbox.Gz
’ however, but an explicit ‘? file mbox.GZ
’ will find and use the handler for ‘gz
’. [v15 behaviour may differ] The latter mode can only be used for MBOX files.EML files consist of only one mail message, [v15 behaviour may differ] and can only be opened read-only. When reading MBOX files tolerant POSIX rules are used by default. Invalid message boundaries that can be found quite often in historic MBOX files will be complained about (even more with debug): in this case the method described for mbox-rfc4155 can be used to create a valid MBOX database from the invalid input.
MBOX databases and EML files will always be protected via file-region locks (fcntl(2)) during file operations to protect against concurrent modifications. [Option] An MBOX inbox (
MAIL
) or primary system mailbox will also be protected by so-called dotlock files, the traditional way of mail spool file locking: for any file ‘x
’ a lock file ‘x.lock
’ will be created during the synchronization, in the same directory and with the same user and group identities as the file of interest — as necessary created by an external privileged dotlock helper. dotlock-disable disables dotlock files. Also see FAQ: Howto handle stale dotlock files.[Option] If no protocol has been fixated, and name refers to a directory with the subdirectories ‘
tmp
’, ‘new
’ and ‘cur
’, then it is treated as a folder in “Maildir” format. The maildir format stores each message in its own file, and has been designed so that file locking is not necessary when reading or writing files.[Option]ally URLs can be used to access network resources, securely via Encrypted network communication, if so supported. Network communication socket timeouts are configurable via socket-connect-timeout. All network traffic may be proxied over a SOCKS server via socks-proxy.
[v15-compat] protocol://[user[:password]@]host[:port][/path]
[no v15-compat] protocol://[user@]host[:port][/path]
[Option]ally supported network protocols are pop3 (POP3) and pop3s (POP3 with TLS encrypted transport), imap and imaps. The [/path] part is valid only for IMAP; there it defaults to INBOX. Network URLs require a special encoding as documented in the section On URL syntax and credential lookup.
folders
- Lists the names of all folders below the given argument or
folder. For file-based protocols
LISTER
will be used for display purposes. Followup
,followup
- (Compose mode)(F,fo) Similar to
Reply
, andreply
, respectively, but save the message in a file named after the local part of the (first) recipient's address, possibly overwriting record, and honouring outfolder. Also seeCopy
andSave
. Forward
- (Compose mode) Similar to
forward
, but saves the message in a file named after the local part of the recipient's address (instead of in record). forward
- (Compose mode) Take a message list and the address of a recipient, subject
to fullnames, to whom the messages are sent. The
text of the original message is included in the new one, enclosed by the
values of forward-inject-head and
forward-inject-tail.
content-description-forwarded-message is inspected.
The list of included headers can be filtered with the
‘
forward
’ slot of the white- and blacklisting commandheaderpick
. Only the first part of a multipart message is included but for forward-as-attachment.This may generate the errors ^ERR-DESTADDRREQ if no receiver has been specified, or was rejected by expandaddr policy, ^ERR-IO if an I/O error occurs, ^ERR-NOTSUP if a necessary character set conversion fails, and ^ERR-INVAL for other errors. It can also fail with errors of Specifying messages. Any error stops processing of further messages.
from
- (f) Takes a list of message specifications and displays a summary of their
message headers, exactly as via
headers
, making the first message of the result the new “dot” (the last message if showlast is set). An alias of this command issearch
. Also see Specifying messages. Fwd
- [Obsolete] Alias for
Forward
. fwd
- [Obsolete] Alias for
forward
. fwdignore
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. fwdretain
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. ghost
,unghost
- [Obsolete] Replaced by
commandalias
,uncommandalias
. headerpick
,unheaderpick
- [Only new quoting rules] Multiplexer command to manage white- and
blacklisting selections of header fields for a variety of applications.
Without arguments the set of contexts that have settings is displayed.
When given arguments, the first argument is the context to which the
command applies, one of (case-insensitive)
‘
type
’ for display purposes (for exampletype
), ‘save
’ for selecting which headers shall be stored persistently whensave
,copy
,move
or evendecrypt
ing messages (note that MIME related etc. header fields should not be ignored in order to not destroy usability of the message in this case), ‘forward
’ for stripping down messages whenforward
ing message (has no effect if forward-as-attachment is set), and ‘top
’ for defining user-defined set of fields for the commandtop
.The current settings of the given context are displayed if it is the only argument. A second argument denotes the type of restriction that is to be chosen, it may be (a case-insensitive prefix of) ‘
retain
’ or ‘ignore
’ for white- and blacklisting purposes, respectively. Establishing a whitelist suppresses inspection of the corresponding blacklist.If no further argument is given the current settings of the given type will be displayed, otherwise the remaining arguments specify header fields, which [Option]ally may be given as regular expressions, to be added to the given type. The special wildcard field (asterisk, ‘
*
’) will establish a (fast) shorthand setting which covers all fields.The latter command always takes three or more arguments and can be used to remove selections, i.e., from the given context, the given type of list, all the given headers will be removed, the special argument ‘
*
’ will remove all headers. headers
- (h) Show the current group of headers, the size of which depends on the variable screen in interactive mode, and the format of which can be defined with headline. If a message-specification is given the group of headers containing the first message therein is shown and the message at the top of the screen becomes the new “dot”; the last message is targeted if showlast is set.
help
- (hel) A synonym for
?
. history
- [Option] Without arguments or when given
show
all history entries are shown (this mode also supports a more verbose output).load
will replace the list of entries with the content of history-file, andsave
will dump all entries to said file, replacing former content, andclear
will delete all entries. The argument can also be a signed decimal NUMBER, which will select and evaluate the respective history entry, and move it to the top of the history; a negative number is used as an offset to the current command so that ‘-1
’ will select the last command, the history top, whereasdelete
will delete all given entries (:NUMBER:). Also see On terminal control and line editor. hold
- (ho, also
preserve
) Takes a message list and marks each message therein to be saved in the user's system inbox instead of in the secondary mailboxMBOX
. Does not override thedelete
command. Mail deviates from the POSIX standard with this command, because anext
command issued afterhold
will display the following message, not the current one. if
- (i) Part of the
if
,elif
,else
,endif
conditional execution construct — if the given condition is true then the encapsulated block is executed. The POSIX standard only supports the (case-insensitive) conditions ‘r
’eceive and ‘s
’end, the remaining are non-portable extensions. [v15 behaviour may differ] In conjunction with thewysh
command prefix(es) Shell-style argument quoting and more test operators are available.if receive commands ... else commands ... endif
Further (case-insensitive) one-argument conditions are ‘
t
’erminal which evaluates to true in interactive terminal sessions (running with standard input or standard output attached to a terminal, and none of the “quickrun” command line options-e
,-H
and-L
have been used), as well as any boolean value (see INTERNAL VARIABLES for textual boolean representations) to mark an enwrapped block as “never execute” or “always execute”. (Remarks: condition syntax errors skip all branches untilendif
.)[no v15-compat] and without
wysh
: It is possible to check INTERNAL VARIABLES as well as ENVIRONMENT variables for existence or compare their expansion against a user given value or another variable by using the ‘$
’ (“variable next”) conditional trigger character; a variable on the right hand side may be signalled using the same mechanism. Variable names may be enclosed in a pair of matching braces. When this mode has been triggered, several operators are available ([v15-compat] andwysh
: they are always available, and there is no trigger: variables will have been expanded by the shell-compatible parser before theif
etc. command sees them).[v15-compat] Two argument conditions. Variables can be tested for existence and expansion: ‘
-N
’ will test whether the given variable exists, so that ‘-N editalong
’ will evaluate to true when editalong is set, whereas ‘-Z editalong
’ will if it is not. ‘-n "$editalong"
’ will be true if the variable is set and expands to a non-empty string, ‘-z $'\$editalong'
’ only if the expansion is empty, whether the variable exists or not. The remaining conditions take three arguments.Integer operators treat the arguments on the left and right hand side of the operator as integral numbers and compare them arithmetically. It is an error if any of the operands is not a valid integer, an empty argument (which implies it had been quoted) is treated as if it were 0. Via the question mark ‘
?
’ modifier suffix a saturated operation mode is available where numbers will linger at the minimum or maximum possible value, instead of overflowing (or trapping), the keyword ‘saturated
’ is optional, ‘==?
’, ‘==?satu
’ and ‘==?saturated
’ are therefore identical. Available operators are ‘-lt
’ (less than), ‘-le
’ (less than or equal to), ‘-eq
’ (equal), ‘-ne
’ (not equal), ‘-ge
’ (greater than or equal to), and ‘-gt
’ (greater than).String and regular expression data operators compare the left and right hand side according to their textual content. Unset variables are treated as the empty string. Via the question mark ‘
?
’ modifier suffix a case-insensitive operation mode is available, the keyword ‘case
’ is optional, ‘==?
’ and ‘==?case
’ are identical.Available string operators are ‘
<
’ (less than), ‘<=
’ (less than or equal to), ‘==
’ (equal), ‘!=
’ (not equal), ‘>=
’ (greater than or equal to), ‘>
’ (greater than), ‘=%
’ (is substring of) and ‘!%
’ (is not substring of). By default these operators work on bytes and (therefore) do not take into account character set specifics. If the case-insensitivity modifier has been used, case is ignored according to the rules of the US-ASCII encoding, i.e., bytes are still compared.When the [Option]al regular expression support is available, the additional string operators ‘
=~
’ and ‘!~
’ can be used. They treat the right hand side as an extended regular expression that is matched according to the active locale (see Character sets), i.e., character sets should be honoured correctly.Conditions can be joined via AND-OR lists (where the AND operator is ‘
&&
’ and the OR operator is ‘||
’), which have equal precedence and will be evaluated with left associativity, thus using the same syntax that is known for the sh(1). It is also possible to form groups of conditions and lists by enclosing them in pairs of brackets ‘[ ... ]
’, which may be interlocked within each other, and also be joined via AND-OR lists.The results of individual conditions and entire groups may be modified via unary operators: the unary operator ‘
!
’ will reverse the result.wysh set v15-compat=yes # with value: automatic "wysh"! if -N debug;echo *debug* set;else;echo not;endif if "$ttycharset" == UTF-8 || "$ttycharset" ==?cas UTF8 echo ttycharset is UTF-8, the former case-sensitive! endif set t1=one t2=one if [ "${t1}" == "${t2}" ] echo These two variables are equal endif if "$features" =% ,+regex, && "$TERM" =~?case ^xterm.* echo ..in an X terminal endif if [ [ true ] && [ [ "${debug}" != '' ] || \ [ "$verbose" != '' ] ] ] echo Noisy, noisy endif if true && [ -n "$debug" || -n "${verbose}" ] echo Left associativity, as is known from the shell endif
ignore
- (ig) Identical to
discard
. Superseded by the multiplexerheaderpick
. list
- Shows the names of all available commands, in command lookup order.
[Option] In conjunction with a set variable verbose
additional information will be provided for each command: the argument
type will be indicated, the documentation string will be shown, and the
set of command flags will show up:
- ‘
`local'
’ - command supports the command modifier
local
. - ‘
`vput'
’ - command supports the command modifier
vput
. - ‘
*!*
’ - the error number is tracked in !.
- ‘
needs-box
’ - whether the command needs an active mailbox, a
folder
. - ‘
ok:
’ - indicators whether command is ...
- ‘
batch/interactive
’ - usable in interactive or batch mode
(
-#
). - ‘
send-mode
’ - usable in send mode.
- ‘
subprocess
’ - allowed to be used when running in a subprocess instance, for example from within a macro that is called via on-compose-splice.
- ‘
- ‘
not ok:
’ - indicators whether command is not ...
- ‘
compose mode
’ - available in Compose mode.
- ‘
startup
’ - available during program startup, like in Resource files.
- ‘
- ‘
gabby
’ - The command produces history-gabby
history
entries.
- ‘
localopts
- Enforce change localization of
environ
(linked) ENVIRONMENT as well as (global) INTERNAL VARIABLES, meaning that their state will be reverted to the former one once the “covered scope” is left. Just like the command modifierlocal
, which provides block-scope localization for some commands (instead), it can only be used inside of macro definition blocks introduced byaccount
ordefine
. The covered scope of anaccount
is left once a different account is activated, and some macros, notably folder-hooks, use their own specific notion of covered scope, here it will be extended until the folder is left again.This setting stacks up: i.e., if ‘
macro1
’ enables change localization and calls ‘macro2
’, which explicitly resets localization, then any value changes within ‘macro2
’ will still be reverted when the scope of ‘macro1
’ is left. (Caveats: if in this example ‘macro2
’ changes to a differentaccount
which sets some variables that are already covered by localizations, their scope will be extended, and in fact leaving theaccount
will (thus) restore settings in (likely) global scope which actually were defined in a local, macro private context!)This command takes one or two arguments, the optional first one specifies an attribute that may be one of
scope
, which refers to the current scope and is thus the default,call
, which causes any macro that is beingcall
ed to be started with localization enabled by default, as well ascall-fixate
, which (if enabled) disallows any called macro to turn off localization: like this it can be ensured that once the current scope regains control, any changes made in deeper levels have been reverted. The latter two are mutually exclusive, and neither affectsxcall
. The (second) argument is interpreted as a boolean (string, see INTERNAL VARIABLES) and states whether the given attribute shall be turned on or off.define temporary_settings { set possibly_global_option1 localopts on set localized_option1 set localized_option2 localopts scope off set possibly_global_option2 }
Lfollowup
,Lreply
- (Compose mode) Reply to messages that come in via known
(
mlist
) or subscribed (mlsubscribe
) mailing lists, or pretend to do so (see Mailing lists): on top of the usualfollowup
andreply
, respectively, functionality this will actively resort and even remove message recipients in order to generate a message that is supposed to be sent to a mailing list. For example it will also implicitly generate a ‘Mail-Followup-To:
’ header if that seems useful, regardless of the setting of the variable followup-to. For more documentation please refer to On sending mail, and non-interactive mode.This may generate the errors ^ERR-DESTADDRREQ if no receiver has been specified, ^ERR-PERM if some addressees where rejected by expandaddr, ^ERR-IO if an I/O error occurs, ^ERR-NOTSUP if a necessary character set conversion fails, and ^ERR-INVAL for other errors. It can also fail with errors of Specifying messages. Occurrence of some of the errors depend on the value of expandaddr. Any error stops processing of further messages.
Mail
- (Compose mode) Similar to
mail
, but saves the message in a file named after the local part of the first recipient's address (instead of in record). mail
- (Compose mode)(m) Takes a (list of) recipient address(es) as (an)
argument(s), or asks on standard input if none were given; then collects
the remaining mail content and sends it out. Unless the internal variable
fullnames is set recipient addresses will be
stripped from comments, names etc. For more documentation please refer to
On sending
mail, and non-interactive mode.
This may generate the errors ^ERR-DESTADDRREQ if no receiver has been specified, ^ERR-PERM if some addressees where rejected by expandaddr, ^ERR-NOTSUP if multiple messages have been specified, ^ERR-IO if an I/O error occurs, ^ERR-NOTSUP if a necessary character set conversion fails, and ^ERR-INVAL for other errors. It can also fail with errors of Specifying messages. Occurrence of some of the errors depend on the value of expandaddr.
mailcap
- [Option] When used without arguments or if show has
been given the content of The
Mailcap files cache is shown, (re-)initializing it first (as
necessary. If the argument is load then the cache
will only be (re-)initialized, and clear will remove
its contents. Note that Mail will try to load the files only once, use
‘
’ to unlock further attempts. Loading and parsing can be made more verbose.mailcap
clear mbox
- (mb) The given message list is to be sent to the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
when Mail is quit; this is the default action unless the variable hold is set. [v15 behaviour may differ] This command can only be used in a primary system mailbox. mimetype
,unmimetype
- [Only new quoting rules] Without arguments the content of the MIME type
cache will displayed; a more verbose listing will be produced if either of
debug or verbose are set. When
given arguments they will be joined, interpreted as shown in
The mime.types files (also
see HTML mail and
MIME attachments), and the resulting entry will be added (prepended)
to the cache. In any event MIME type sources are loaded first as necessary
– mimetypes-load-control can be used to
fine-tune which sources are actually loaded.
The latter command deletes all specifications of the given MIME type, thus ‘
? unmimetype text/plain
’ will remove all registered specifications for the MIME type ‘text/plain
’. The special name ‘*
’ will discard all existing MIME types, just as will ‘reset
’, but which also reenables cache initialization via mimetypes-load-control. mimeview
- [v15 behaviour may differ] Only available in interactive mode, this
command allows execution of external MIME type handlers which do not
integrate into the normal
type
output (see HTML mail and MIME attachments). ([v15 behaviour may differ] No syntax to directly address parts, this restriction may vanish.) The user will be asked for each non-text part of the given message in turn whether the registered handler shall be used to display the part. mlist
,unmlist
- [Only new quoting rules] Manage the list of known
Mailing lists; subscriptions are
controlled via
mlsubscribe
. The latter command deletes all given arguments, or all at once when given the asterisk ‘*
’. The former shows the list of all currently known lists if used without arguments, otherwise the given arguments will become known. [Option] In the latter case, arguments which contain any of the magic regular expression characters will be interpreted as one, possibly matching many addresses; these will be sequentially matched via linked lists instead of being looked up in a dictionary. mlsubscribe
,unmlsubscribe
- Building upon the command pair
mlist
,unmlist
, but only managing the subscription attribute of mailing lists. (The former will also create not yet existing mailing lists.) Move
- Similar to
move
, but move the messages to a file named after the local part of the sender of the first message instead of taking a filename argument; outfolder is inspected to decide on the actual storage location. move
- Acts like
copy
but marks the messages for deletion if they were transferred successfully. More
- Like
more
, but also displays header fields which would not pass theheaderpick
selection, and all MIME parts. Identical toPage
. more
- Invokes the
PAGER
on the given messages, even in non-interactive mode and as long as the standard output is a terminal. Identical topage
. mtaaliases
- [Option] When used without arguments or if show has been given the content of the mta-aliases cache is shown, (re-)initializing it first (as necessary). If the argument is load then the cache will only be (re-)initialized, and clear will remove its contents.
netrc
- [Option] When used without arguments, or when the argument was
show the content of the
~/.netrc cache is shown, initializing it as
necessary. If the argument is load then the cache
will be (re)loaded, whereas clear removes it.
Loading and parsing can be made more verbose.
lookup will query the cache for the URL given as the
second argument (‘
[USER@]HOST
’). See netrc-lookup, netrc-pipe and the section On URL syntax and credential lookup; the section The .netrc file documents the file format in detail. newmail
- Checks for new mail in the current folder without committing any changes before. If new mail is present, a message is shown. If the header variable is set, the headers of each new message are also shown. This command is not available for all mailbox types.
next
- (n) (like ‘
+
’ or “ENTER”) Goes to the next message in sequence and types it. With an argument list, types the next matching message. New
- Same as
Unread
. new
- Same as
unread
. noop
- If the current folder is accessed via a network connection, a “NOOP” command is sent, otherwise no operation is performed.
Page
- Like
page
, but also displays header fields which would not pass theheaderpick
selection, and all MIME parts. Identical toMore
. page
- Invokes the
PAGER
on the given messages, even in non-interactive mode and as long as the standard output is a terminal. Identical tomore
. Pipe
- Like
pipe
but also pipes header fields which would not pass theheaderpick
selection, and all parts of MIME ‘multipart/alternative
’ messages. pipe
- (pi) Takes an optional message list and shell command (that defaults to cmd), and pipes the messages through the command. If the page variable is set, every message is followed by a formfeed character.
preserve
- (pre) A synonym for
hold
. Print
- (P) Alias for
Type
. print
- (p) Research UNIX equivalent of
type
. quit
- (q) Terminates the session, saving all undeleted, unsaved messages in the
current secondary mailbox
MBOX
, preserving all messages marked withhold
orpreserve
or never referenced in the system inbox, and removing all other messages from the primary system mailbox. If new mail has arrived during the session, the message “You have new mail” will be shown. If given while editing a mailbox file with the command line option-f
, then the edit file is rewritten. A return to the shell is effected, unless the rewrite of edit file fails, in which case the user can escape with the exit command. The optional status number argument will be passed through to exit(3). [v15 behaviour may differ] For now it can happen that the given status will be overwritten, later this will only occur if a later error needs to be reported onto an otherwise success indicating status. read
- [Only new quoting rules] Read a line from standard input, or the channel
set active via
readctl
, and assign the data, which will be split as indicated by ifs, to the given variables. The variable names are checked by the same rules as documented forvput
, and the same error codes will be seen in !; the exit status ? indicates the number of bytes read, it will be ‘-1
’ with the error number ! set to ^ERR-BADF in case of I/O errors, or ^ERR-NONE upon End-Of-File. If there are more fields than variables, assigns successive fields to the last given variable. If there are less fields than variables, assigns the empty string to the remains.? read a b c H e l l o ? echo "<$a> <$b> <$c>" <H> <e> <l l o> ? wysh set ifs=:; read a b c;unset ifs hey2.0,:"'you ",:world!:mars.: ? echo $?/$^ERRNAME / <$a><$b><$c> 0/NONE / <hey2.0,><"'you ",><world!:mars.:><><>
readsh
- [Only new quoting rules] Like
read
, but splits on shell token boundaries (see Shell-style argument quoting) rather than at ifs. [v15 behaviour may differ] Could become acommandalias
, maybe ‘read --tokenize --
’. readall
- [Only new quoting rules] Read anything from standard input, or the channel
set active via
readctl
, and assign the data to the given variable. The variable name is checked by the same rules as documented forvput
, and the same error codes will be seen in !; the exit status ? indicates the number of bytes read, it will be ‘-1
’ with the error number ! set to ^ERR-BADF in case of I/O errors, or ^ERR-NONE upon End-Of-File. [v15 behaviour may differ] The input data length is restricted to 31-bits. readctl
- [Only new quoting rules] Manages input channels for
read
,readsh
andreadall
, to be used to avoid complicated or impracticable code, like callingread
from within a macro in non-interactive mode. Without arguments, or when the first argument isshow
, a listing of all known channels is printed. Channels can otherwise becreate
d, and existing channels can beset
active andremove
d by giving the string used for creation.The channel name is expected to be a file descriptor number, or, if parsing the numeric fails, an input file name that undergoes Filename transformations. For example (this example requires a modern shell):
$ printf 'echon "hey, "\nread a\nyou\necho $a' |\ mail -R# hey, you $ LC_ALL=C printf 'echon "hey, "\nread a\necho $a' |\ LC_ALL=C 6<<< 'you' mail -R#X'readctl create 6' hey, you
remove
- [Only new quoting rules] Removes the named files or directories. If a name refers to a mailbox, say a Maildir mailbox, then a mailbox type specific removal will be performed, deleting the complete mailbox. In interactive mode the user is asked for confirmation.
rename
- [Only new quoting rules] Takes the name of an existing folder and the name for the new folder and renames the first to the second one. Filename transformations including shell pathname wildcard pattern expansions (glob(7)) are performed on both arguments. Both folders must be of the same type.
Reply
,Respond
- (Compose mode)(R) Identical to
reply
except that it replies to only the sender of each message of the given list, by using the first message as the template to quote, for the ‘Subject:
’ etc.; setting flipr will exchange this command withreply
. reply
,respond
- (Compose mode)(r) Take a message (list) and group-respond (to each in
turn) by addressing the sender and all recipients, subject to
fullnames and
alternates
processing. followup-to, followup-to-honour, reply-to-honour as well as recipients-in-cc influence response behaviour. quote as well as quote-as-attachment configure whether responded-to message shall be quoted etc., content-description-quote-attachment may be used. Setting flipr will exchange this command withReply
. The commandLreply
offers special support for replying to mailing lists. For more documentation please refer to On sending mail, and non-interactive mode.This may generate the errors ^ERR-DESTADDRREQ if no receiver has been specified, or was rejected by expandaddr policy, ^ERR-IO if an I/O error occurs, ^ERR-NOTSUP if a necessary character set conversion fails, and ^ERR-INVAL for other errors. It can also fail with errors of Specifying messages. Any error stops processing of further messages.
Resend
- Like
resend
, but does not add any header lines. This is not a way to hide the sender's identity, but useful for sending a message again to the same recipients. resend
- Takes a list of messages and a name, and sends each message to the given
addressee, which is subject to fullnames.
‘
Resent-From:
’ and related header fields are prepended to the new copy of the message. Saving in record is only performed if record-resent is set. [v15 behaviour may differ](Compose mode) is not entered, the only supported hooks are on-resend-enter and on-resend-cleanup.This may generate the errors ^ERR-DESTADDRREQ if no receiver has been specified, or was rejected by expandaddr policy, ^ERR-IO if an I/O error occurs, ^ERR-NOTSUP if a necessary character set conversion fails, and ^ERR-INVAL for other errors. It can also fail with errors of Specifying messages. Any error stops processing of further messages.
retain
- (ret) Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. return
- Only available inside of a
define
d macro or anaccount
, this command returns control of execution to the outer scope. The two optional parameters are positive decimal numbers and default to 0: the first specifies the 32-bit return value (stored in ? [v15 behaviour may differ] and later extended to 64-bit), the second the 32-bit error number (stored in !). As documented for ? a non-0 exit status may cause the program to exit. Save
- (S) Similar to
save,
but saves the messages in a file named after the local part of the sender of the first message instead of taking a filename argument; outfolder is inspected to decide on the actual storage location. save
- (s) Takes a message list and a filename and appends each message in turn
to the end of the file.
Filename
transformations including shell pathname wildcard pattern expansions
(glob(7)) is performed on the
filename. If no filename is given, the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
is used. The filename in quotes, followed by the generated character count is echoed on the user's terminal. If editing a primary system mailbox the messages are marked for deletion. To filter the saved header fields to the desired subset use the ‘save
’ slot of the white- and blacklisting commandheaderpick
. Also seeCopy
. savediscard
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. saveignore
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. saveretain
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. search
- Takes a message specification (list) and displays a header summary of all
matching messages, as via
headers
. This command is an alias offrom
. Also see Specifying messages. seen
- Takes a message list and marks all messages as having been read.
set
,unset
- (se, [Only new quoting rules] uns) The latter command will delete all
given global variables, or only block-scope local ones if the
local
command modifier has been used. The former, when used without arguments, will show all currently known variables, being more verbose if either of debug or verbose is set. Remarks: this list mode will not automatically link-in (known) ENVIRONMENT variables, this only happens for explicit addressing, examples arevarshow
, using a variable in anif
condition or a string passed toecho
, explicitset
ting, as well as some program-internal use cases (look-ups).Otherwise the given variables (and arguments) are set or adjusted. Arguments are of the form ‘
name=value
’ (no space before or after ‘=
’), or plain ‘name
’ if there is no value, i.e., a boolean variable. If a name begins with ‘no
’, as in ‘set nosave
’, the effect is the same as invoking theunset
command with the remaining part of the variable (‘unset save
’). [v15 behaviour may differ] In conjunction with thewysh
(orlocal
) command prefix(es) Shell-style argument quoting can be used to quote arguments as necessary. [v15 behaviour may differ] Otherwise quotation marks may be placed around any part of the assignment statement to quote blanks or tabs.When operating in global scope any ‘
name
’ that is known to map to an environment variable will automatically cause updates in the program environment (unsetting a variable in the environment requires corresponding system support) — use the commandenviron
for further environmental control. If the command modifierlocal
has been used to enforce local scoping then the given user variables will be garbage collected when the local scope is left; for INTERNAL VARIABLES, however,local
behaves the same as iflocalopts
would have been set (temporarily), which means that changes are inherited by deeper scopes. Also seevarshow
and the sections INTERNAL VARIABLES and ENVIRONMENT.? wysh set indentprefix=' -> ' ? wysh set atab=$'' aspace=' ' zero=0
shcodec
- Apply shell quoting rules to the given raw-data arguments. Supports
vput
(see Command modifiers). The first argument specifies the operation: [+]e[ncode] or d[ecode] cause shell quoting to be applied to the remains of the line, and expanded away thereof, respectively. If the former is prefixed with a plus-sign, the quoted result will not be roundtrip enabled, and thus can be decoded only in the very same environment that was used to perform the encode; also seemle-quote-rndtrip
. If the coding operation fails the error number ! is set to ^ERR-CANCELED, and the unmodified input is used as the result; the error number may change again due to output or result storage errors. shell
- [Only new quoting rules] (sh) Invokes an interactive version of the shell, and returns its exit status.
shortcut
,unshortcut
- [Only new quoting rules] Manage the file- or pathname shortcuts as
documented for
folder
. The latter command deletes all shortcuts given as arguments, or all at once when given the asterisk ‘*
’. The former shows the list of all currently defined shortcuts if used without arguments, the target of the given with a single argument. Otherwise arguments are treated as pairs of shortcuts and their desired expansion, creating new or updating already existing ones. shift
- [Only new quoting rules] Shift the positional parameter stack (starting at
1) by the given number (which must be a positive
decimal), or 1 if no argument has been given. It is an error if the value
exceeds the number of positional parameters. If the given number is 0, no
action is performed, successfully. The stack as such can be managed via
vpospar
. Note this command will fail inaccount
and hook macros unless the positional parameter stack has been explicitly created in the current context viavpospar
. show
- Like
type
, but performs neither MIME decoding nor decryption, so that the raw message text is shown. size
- (si) Shows the size in characters of each message of the given message list.
sleep
- [Only new quoting rules] Sleep for the specified number of seconds (and optionally milliseconds), by default interruptible. If a third argument is given the sleep will be uninterruptible, otherwise the error number ! will be set to ^ERR-INTR if the sleep has been interrupted. The command will fail and the error number will be ^ERR-OVERFLOW if the given duration(s) overflow the time datatype, and ^ERR-INVAL if the given durations are no valid integers.
sort
,unsort
- The latter command disables sorted or threaded mode, returns to normal
message order and, if the header variable is set,
displays a header summary. The former command shows the current sorting
criterion when used without an argument, but creates a sorted
representation of the current folder otherwise, and changes the
next
command and the addressing modes such that they refer to messages in the sorted order. Message numbers are the same as in regular mode. If the header variable is set, a header summary in the new order is also displayed. Automatic folder sorting can be enabled by setting the autosort variable, as in ‘set autosort=thread
’. Possible sorting criterions are:- date
- Sort the messages by their
‘
Date:
’ field, that is by the time they were sent. - from
- Sort messages by the value of their
‘
From:
’ field, that is by the address of the sender. If the showname variable is set, the sender's real name (if any) is used. - size
- Sort the messages by their size.
- spam
- [Option] Sort the message by their spam score, as has been classified
by
spamrate
. - status
- Sort the messages by their message status.
- subject
- Sort the messages by their subject.
- thread
- Create a threaded display.
- to
- Sort messages by the value of their
‘
To:
’ field, that is by the address of the recipient. If the showname variable is set, the recipient's real name (if any) is used.
source
- [Only new quoting rules] (so) The source command reads commands from the
given file. Filename
transformations will be applied. If the given expanded argument ends
with a vertical bar ‘
|
’ then the argument will instead be interpreted as a shell command and Mail will read the output generated by it. Dependent on the settings of posix and errexit, and also dependent on whether the command modifierignerr
had been used, encountering errors will stop sourcing of the given input. [v15 behaviour may differ] Note thatsource
cannot be used from within macros that execute as folder-hooks oraccount
s, i.e., it can only be called from macros that werecall
ed. source_if
- [Only new quoting rules] The difference to
source
(beside not supporting pipe syntax aka shell command input) is that this command will not generate an error nor warn if the given file argument cannot be opened successfully. spamclear
- [Option] Takes a list of messages and clears their
‘
is-spam
’ flag. spamforget
- [Option] Takes a list of messages and causes the
spam-interface to forget it has ever used them to
train its Bayesian filter. Unless otherwise noted the
‘
is-spam
’ flag of the message is inspected to chose whether a message shall be forgotten to be “ham” or “spam”. spamham
- [Option] Takes a list of messages and informs the Bayesian filter of the
spam-interface that they are “ham”.
This also clears the ‘
is-spam
’ flag of the messages in question. spamrate
- [Option] Takes a list of messages and rates them using the configured
spam-interface, without modifying the messages, but
setting their ‘
is-spam
’ flag as appropriate; because the spam rating headers are lost the rate will be forgotten once the mailbox is left. Refer to the manual section Handling spam for the complete picture of spam handling in Mail. spamset
- [Option] Takes a list of messages and sets their
‘
is-spam
’ flag. spamspam
- [Option] Takes a list of messages and informs the Bayesian filter of the
spam-interface that they are “spam”.
This also sets the ‘
is-spam
’ flag of the messages in question. thread
- [Obsolete] The same as ‘
sort thread
’ (consider using a ‘commandalias
’ as necessary). tls
- [Only new quoting rules] TLS information and management command
multiplexer to aid in
Encrypted network
communication, mostly available only if the term
‘
,+sockets,
’ is included in features. Commands supportvput
if so documented (see Command modifiers). The result that is shown in case of errors is always the empty string, errors can be identified via the error number !. For example, string length overflows are caught and set ! to ^ERR-OVERFLOW. The TLS configuration is honoured, especially tls-verify.? vput tls result fingerprint pop3s://ex.am.ple ? echo $?/$!/$^ERRNAME: $result
certchain
- Show the complete verified peer certificate chain. Includes informational fields in conjunction with verbose.
certificate
- Show only the peer certificate, without any signers. Includes informational fields in conjunction with verbose.
fingerprint
- Show the tls-fingerprint-digested fingerprint of
the certificate of the given HOST
(‘
server:port
’, where the port defaults to the HTTPS port, 443). tls-fingerprint is actively ignored for the runtime of this command.
Top
- Like
top
but always uses theheaderpick
‘type
’ slot for white- and blacklisting header fields. top
- (to) Takes a message list and types out the first
toplines lines of each message on the user's
terminal. Unless a special selection has been established for the
‘
top
’ slot of theheaderpick
command, the only header fields that are displayed are ‘From:
’, ‘To:
’, ‘Cc:
’, and ‘Subject:
’.Top
will always use the ‘type
’headerpick
selection instead. It is possible to apply compression to what is displayed by setting topsqueeze. Messages are decrypted and converted to the terminal character set if necessary. touch
- (tou) Takes a message list and marks the messages for saving in the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
. Mail deviates from the POSIX standard with this command, as a followingnext
command will display the following message instead of the current one. Type
- (T) Like
type
but also displays header fields which would not pass theheaderpick
selection, and all visualizable parts of MIME ‘multipart/alternative
’ messages. type
- (t) Takes a message list and types out each message on the user's
terminal. The display of message headers is selectable via
headerpick
. For MIME multipart messages, all parts with a content type of ‘text
’, all parts which have a registered MIME type handler (see HTML mail and MIME attachments) which produces plain text output, and all ‘message
’ parts are shown, others are hidden except for their headers. Messages are decrypted and converted to the terminal character set if necessary. The commandmimeview
can be used to display parts which are not displayable as plain text. unaccount
- See
account
. unalias
- (una) See
alias
. unanswered
- See
answered
. unbind
- See
bind
. uncollapse
- See
collapse
. uncolour
- See
colour
. undefine
- See
define
. undelete
- See
delete
. undraft
- See
draft
. unflag
- See
flag
. unfwdignore
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. unfwdretain
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. unignore
- Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. unmimetype
- See
mimetype
. unmlist
- See
mlist
. unmlsubscribe
- See
mlsubscribe
. Unread
- Same as
unread
. unread
- Takes a message list and marks each message as not having been read.
unretain
- Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. unsaveignore
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. unsaveretain
- [Obsolete] Superseded by the multiplexer
headerpick
. unset
- [Only new quoting rules] (uns) See
set
. unshortcut
- See
shortcut
. unsort
- See
short
. unthread
- [Obsolete] Same as
unsort
. urlcodec
- Perform URL percent codec operations on the raw-data argument, rather
according to RFC 3986. The first argument specifies the operation:
e[ncode] or d[ecode] perform
plain URL percent en- and decoding, respectively.
p[ath]enc[ode] and
p[ath]dec[ode] perform a slightly modified operation
which should be better for pathnames: it does not allow a tilde
‘
~
’, and will neither accept hyphen-minus ‘-
’ nor dot ‘’. as an initial character. The remains of the line form the URL data which is to be converted. This is a character set agnostic operation, and it may thus decode bytes which are invalid in the current ttycharset.
Supports
vput
(see Command modifiers), and manages the error number !. If the coding operation fails the error number ! is set to ^ERR-CANCELED, and the unmodified input is used as the result; the error number may change again due to output or result storage errors. [v15 behaviour may differ] This command does not know about URLs beside what is documented. (vexpr
offers amakeprint
subcommand, shall the URL be displayed.) varshow
- [Only new quoting rules] This command produces the same output as the
listing mode of
set
, including verboseity adjustments, but only for the given variables. verify
- [Option] Takes a message list and verifies each message. If a message is not a S/MIME signed message, verification will fail for it. The verification process checks if the message was signed using a valid certificate, if the message sender's email address matches one of those contained within the certificate, and if the message content has been altered.
version
- Shows the version and features
of Mail, optionally in a more verbose form which
also includes the build and running system environment. This command
supports
vput
(see Command modifiers). vexpr
- [Only new quoting rules] A multiplexer command which offers signed 64-bit
numeric calculations, as well as other, mostly string-based operations.
C-style byte string operations are available via
csop
. The first argument defines the number, type, and meaning of the remaining arguments. An empty number argument is treated as 0. Supportsvput
(see Command modifiers). The result shown in case of errors is ‘-1
’ for usage errors and numeric operations, the empty string otherwise; “soft” errors, like when a search operation failed, will also set the ! error number to ^ERR-NODATA. Except when otherwise noted numeric arguments are parsed as signed 64-bit numbers, and errors will be reported in the error number ! as the numeric error ^ERR-RANGE.Numeric operations work on one or two signed 64-bit integers. Numbers prefixed with ‘
0x
’ or ‘0X
’ are interpreted as hexadecimal (base 16) numbers, whereas ‘0
’ indicates octal (base 8), and ‘0b
’ as well as ‘0B
’ denote binary (base 2) numbers. It is possible to use any base in between 2 and 36, inclusive, with the ‘BASE#number
’ notation, where the base is given as an unsigned decimal number, so ‘16#AFFE
’ is a different way of specifying a hexadecimal number. Unsigned interpretation of a number can be enforced by prefixing an ‘u
’ (case-insensitively), as in ‘u-110
’; this is not necessary for power-of-two bases (2, 4, 8, 16 and 32), which will be interpreted as unsigned by default, but it still makes a difference regarding overflow detection and overflow constant. It is possible to enforce signed interpretation by (instead) prefixing a ‘s
’ (case-insensitively). The number sign notation uses a permissive parse mode and as such supports complicated conditions out of the box:? wysh set ifs=:;read i;unset ifs;echo $i;vexpr pb 2 10#$i -009 < -009> 0b1001
One integer is expected by assignment (equals sign ‘
=
’), which does nothing but parsing the argument, thus detecting validity and possible overflow conditions, unary not (tilde ‘~
’), which creates the bitwise complement, and unary plus and minus. Two integers are used by addition (plus sign ‘+
’), subtraction (hyphen-minus ‘-
’), multiplication (asterisk ‘*
’), division (solidus ‘/
’) and modulo (percent sign ‘%
’), as well as for the bitwise operators logical or (vertical bar ‘|
’, to be quoted) , bitwise and (ampersand ‘&
’, to be quoted) , bitwise xor (circumflex ‘^
’), the bitwise signed left- and right shifts (‘<<
’, ‘>>
’), as well as for the unsigned right shift ‘>>>
’.Another numeric operation is
pbase
, which takes a number base in between 2 and 36, inclusive, and will act on the second number given just the same as what equals sign ‘=
’ does, but the number result will be formatted in the base given, as a signed 64-bit number unless unsigned interpretation of the input number had been forced (with an u prefix).Numeric operations support a saturated mode via the question mark ‘
?
’ modifier suffix; the keyword ‘saturated
’ is optional, ‘+?
’, ‘+?satu
’, and ‘+?saturated
’ are therefore identical. In saturated mode overflow errors and division and modulo by zero are no longer reported via the exit status, but the result will linger at the minimum or maximum possible value, instead of overflowing (or trapping). This is true also for the argument parse step. For the bitwise shifts, the saturated maximum is 63. Any caught overflow will be reported via the error number ! as ^ERR-OVERFLOW.? vput vexpr res -? +1 -9223372036854775808 ? echo $?/$!/$^ERRNAME:$res 0/75/OVERFLOW:-9223372036854775808
Character set agnostic string functions have no notion of locale settings and character sets.
date-utc
- Outputs the current date and time in UTC (Coordinated Universal Time)
with values named such that ‘
vput vexpr x date-utc; eval wysh set $x
’ creates accessible variables. date-stamp-utc
- Outputs a RFC 3339 internet date/time format of UTC.
epoch
- The seconds and nanoseconds since the Unix epoch (1970-01-01T00:00:00)
named ‘
epoch_sec
’ and ‘epoch_nsec
’ such that ‘vput vexpr x epoch; eval wysh set $x
’ creates accessible variables. file-expand
- Performs the usual Filename transformations on its argument.
file-stat
,file-lstat
- Perform the usual
Filename
transformations on the argument, then call
stat(2) and
lstat(2), respectively, and
output values such that ‘
vput vexpr x file-stat FILE; eval wysh set $x
’ creates accessible variables. The variable ‘st_type
’ uses solidus ‘/
’ to denote directories, commercial at ‘@
’ for links, number sign ‘#
’ for block devices, percent sign ‘%
’ for for character devices, vertical bar ‘|
’ for FIFOs, equal sign ‘=
’ for sockets, and the period ‘.
’ for the rest. random
- Generates a random string of the given length, or of
PATH_MAX
bytes (a constant from /usr/include) if the value 0 is given; the random string will be base64url encoded according to RFC 4648, and thus be usable as a (portable) filename.
String operations work, sufficient support provided, according to the active user's locale encoding and character set (see Character sets). Where the question mark ‘
?
’ modifier suffix is supported, a case-insensitive operation mode is available; the keyword ‘case
’ is optional, ‘regex?
’ and ‘regex?case
’ are therefore identical.makeprint
- (One-way) Converts the argument to something safely printable on the terminal.
regex
- [Option] A string operation that will try to match the first argument
with the regular expression given as the second argument.
‘
?
’ modifier suffix is supported. If the optional third argument has been given then instead of showing the match offset a replacement operation is performed: the third argument is treated as if specified within dollar-single-quote (see Shell-style argument quoting), and any occurrence of a positional parameter, for example 0, 1 etc. is replaced with the according match group of the regular expression:? vput vexpr res regex bananarama \ (.*)NanA(.*) '\${1}au\$2' ? echo $?/$!/$^ERRNAME:$res: 1/61/NODATA:: ? vput vexpr res regex?case bananarama \ (.*)NanA(.*) '\${1}uauf\$2' ? echo $?/$!/$^ERRNAME:$res: 0/0/NONE:bauauframa:
vpospar
- [Only new quoting rules] Manage the positional parameter stack (see
1, #, *,
@ as well as
shift
). If the first argument is ‘clear
’, then the positional parameter stack of the current context, or the global one, if there is none, is cleared. If it is ‘set
’, then the remaining arguments will be used to (re)create the stack, if the parameter stack size limit is excessed an ^ERR-OVERFLOW error will occur.If the first argument is ‘
quote
’, a round-trip capable representation of the stack contents is created, with each quoted parameter separated from each other with the first character of ifs, and followed by the first character of if-ws, if that is not empty and not identical to the first. If that results in no separation at all aspace
character is used. This mode supportsvput
(see Command modifiers). I.e., the subcommands ‘set
’ and ‘quote
’ can be used (in conjunction witheval
) to (re)create an argument stack from and to a single variable losslessly.? vpospar set hey, "'you ", world! ? echo $#: <${1}><${2}><${3}> ? vput vpospar x quote ? vpospar clear ? echo $#: <${1}><${2}><${3}> ? eval vpospar set ${x} ? echo $#: <${1}><${2}><${3}>
visual
- (v) Takes a message list and invokes the
VISUAL
display editor on each message. Modified contents are discarded unless the writebackedited variable is set, and are not used unless the mailbox can be written to and the editor returns a successful exit status.edit
can be used instead for a less display oriented editor. write
- (w) For conventional messages the body without all headers is written. The
original message is never marked for deletion in the originating mail
folder. The output is decrypted and converted to its native format as
necessary. If the output file exists, the text is appended. If a message
is in MIME multipart format its first part is written to the specified
file as for conventional messages, handling of the remains depends on the
execution mode. No special handling of compressed files is performed.
In interactive mode the user is consecutively asked for the filenames of the processed parts. For convenience saving of each part may be skipped by giving an empty value, the same result as writing it to /dev/null. Shell piping the part content by specifying a leading vertical bar ‘
|
’ character for the filename is supported. Other user input undergoes the usual Filename transformations, including shell pathname wildcard pattern expansions (glob(7)) and shell variable expansion for the message as such, not the individual parts, and contents of the destination file are overwritten if the file previously existed. Character set conversion to ttycharset is performed when saving text data.[v15 behaviour may differ] In non-interactive mode any part which does not specify a filename is ignored, and suspicious parts of filenames of the remaining parts are URL percent encoded (as via
urlcodec
) to prevent injection of malicious character sequences, resulting in a filename that will be written into the current directory. Existing files will not be overwritten, instead the part number or a dot are appended after a number sign ‘#
’ to the name until file creation succeeds (or fails due to other reasons). xcall
- [Only new quoting rules] The sole difference to
call
is that the new macro is executed in place of the current one, which will not regain control: all resources of the current macro will be released first. This implies that any setting covered bylocalopts
will be forgotten and covered variables will become cleaned up. If this command is not used from within acall
ed macro it will silently be (a more expensive variant of)call
. xit
- (x) A synonym for
exit
. z
- [Only new quoting rules] Mail presents message headers in
screenfuls as described under the
headers
command. Without arguments this command scrolls to the next window of messages, likewise if the argument is ‘+
’. An argument of ‘-
’ scrolls to the last, ‘^
’ scrolls to the first, and ‘$
’ to the last screen of messages. A number argument prefixed by ‘+
’ or ‘-
’ indicates that the window is calculated in relation to the current position, and a number without a prefix specifies an absolute position. Z
- [Only new quoting rules] Similar to
z
, but scrolls to the next or previous window that contains at least one ‘new
’ orflag
ged message.
COMMAND ESCAPES
Command escapes are available in
Compose mode during interactive
usage, when explicitly requested via -~
, and in
batch mode (-#
). They perform special functions,
like editing headers of the message being composed, calling normal
COMMANDS, yielding a shell, etc. Command
escapes are only recognized at the beginning of lines, and consist of an
escape followed by a command character. The default
escape character is the tilde
‘~
’.
Unless otherwise documented command escapes ensure proper updates of the error number ! and the exit status ?. The variable errexit controls whether a failed operation errors out message compose mode and causes program exit. Escapes may be prefixed by none to multiple single character command modifiers, interspersed whitespace is ignored:
- An effect equivalent to the command modifier
ignerr
can be achieved with hyphen-minus ‘-
’, overriding errexit. - The modifier dollar ‘
$
’eval
uates the remains of the line; also see Shell-style argument quoting. [v15 behaviour may differ] For now the entire input line is evaluated as a whole; to avoid that control operators like semicolon;
are interpreted unintentionally, they must be quoted.
Addition of the command line to the [Option]al history can be
prevented by placing whitespace directly after escape.
The [Option]al key bind
ings support a compose mode
specific context. The following command escapes are supported:
~~
string- Insert the string of text in the message prefaced by a single
‘
~
’. (If the escape character has been changed, that character must be doubled instead.) ~!
command- Execute the indicated shell command which follows, replacing unescaped exclamation marks with the previously executed command if the internal variable bang is set, then return to the message.
~.
- End compose mode and send the message. The hooks on-compose-splice-shell and on-compose-splice, in order, will be called when set, after which, in interactive mode askatend (leading to askcc, askbcc) and askattach will be checked as well as asksend, after which a set on-compose-leave hook will be called, autocc and autobcc will be joined in if set, finally a given message-inject-tail will be incorporated, after which the compose mode is left.
~:
Mail-command or~_
Mail-command- Can be used to execute COMMANDS (which are allowed in compose mode).
~<
filename- Identical to
~r
. ~<!
command- command is executed using the shell. Its standard output is inserted into the message.
~?
- [Option] Write a summary of command escapes.
~@
[filename...]- Append or edit the list of attachments. Does not manage the error number
! and the exit status ?
(please use
~^
if error handling is necessary). The append mode expects a list of filename arguments as shell tokens (see Shell-style argument quoting; token-separating commas are ignored, too), to be interpreted as documented for the command line option-a
, with the message number exception as below.Without filename arguments the attachment list is edited, entry by entry; if a filename is left empty, that attachment is deleted from the list; once the end of the list is reached either new attachments may be entered or the session can be quit by committing an empty “new” attachment. In non-interactive mode or in batch mode (
-#
) the list of attachments is effectively not edited but instead recreated; again, an empty input ends list creation.For all modes, if a given filename solely consists of the number sign ‘
#
’ followed by either a valid message number of the currently active mailbox, or by a period ‘.
’, referring to the current message of the active mailbox, the so-called “dot”, then the given message is attached as a ‘message/rfc822
’ MIME message part. The number sign must be quoted to avoid misinterpretation as a shell comment character. ~|
command- Pipe the message text through the specified filter command. If the command
gives no output or terminates abnormally, retain the original text of the
message. The command fmt(1) is
often used as a rejustifying filter.
If the first character of the command is a vertical bar, then the entire message including header fields is subject to the filter command, so ‘
~|| echo Fcc: /tmp/test; cat
’ will prepend a file-carbon-copy message header. Also see~e
,~v
. ~^
cmd [subcmd [arg3 [arg4]]]- Inspect and modify the message using the semantics of
digmsg
, therefore arguments are evaluated according to Shell-style argument quoting. Error number ! and exit status ? are not managed: errors are handled via the protocol, and hard errors like I/O failures cannot be handled.The protocol consists of command lines followed by (a) response line(s). The first field of the response line represents a status code which specifies whether a command was successful or not, whether result data is to be expected, and if, the format of the result data. Response data will be shell quoted as necessary for consumption by
readsh
, oreval
andvpospar
, to name a few. Error status code lines may optionally contain additional context:- ‘
210
’ - Status ok; the remains of the line are the result.
- ‘
211
’ - Status ok; the rest of the line is optionally used for more status.
What follows are lines of result addresses, terminated by an empty
line. All the input, including the empty line, must be consumed before
further commands can be issued. Address lines consist of two token,
first the plain network address, e.g.,
‘
bob@exam.ple
’, followed by the (quoted) full address as known: ‘'(Lovely) Bob <bob@exam.ple>'
’. Non-network addresses use the first field to indicate the type (hyphen-minus ‘-
’ for files, vertical bar ‘|
’ for pipes, and number sign ‘#
’ for names which will undergoalias
processing) instead, the actual value will be in the second field. - ‘
212
’ - Status ok; the rest of the line is optionally used for more status. What follows are lines of furtherly unspecified (quoted) string content, terminated by an empty line. All the input, including the empty line, must be consumed before further commands can be issued.
- ‘
500
’ - Syntax error; invalid command.
- ‘
501
’ - Syntax error or otherwise invalid parameters or arguments.
- ‘
505
’ - Error: an argument fails verification. For example an invalid address has been specified (also see expandaddr), or an attempt was made to modify anything in Mail's own namespace, or a modifying subcommand has been used on a read-only message.
- ‘
506
’ - Error: an otherwise valid argument is rendered invalid due to context. For example, a second address is added to a header which may consist of a single address only.
If a command indicates failure then the message will have remained unmodified. Most commands can fail with ‘
500
’ if required arguments are missing, or excessive arguments have been given (false command usage). ([v15 behaviour may differ] The latter does not yet occur regularly, because as stated in Shell-style argument quoting our argument parser is not yet smart enough to work on subcommand base; for example one might get excess argument error for a three argument subcommand that receives four arguments, but not for a four argument subcommand which receives six arguments: here excess will be joined.) The following (case-insensitive) commands are supported:attachment
- This command allows listing, removal and addition of message
attachments. The second argument specifies the subcommand to apply,
one of:
attribute
- This uses the same search mechanism as described for
remove
and prints any known attributes of the first found attachment via ‘212
’ upon success or ‘501
’ if no such attachment can be found. The attributes are written as lines with a keyword and a value token. attribute-at
- This uses the same search mechanism as described for
remove-at
and is otherwise identical toattribute
. attribute-set
- This uses the same search mechanism as described for
remove
, and will set the attribute given as the fourth to the value given as the fifth token argument. If the value is an empty token, then the given attribute is removed, or reset to a default value if existence of the attribute is crucial.It returns via ‘
210
’ upon success, with the index of the found attachment following, ‘505
’ for message attachments or if the given keyword is invalid, and ‘501
’ if no such attachment can be found. The following keywords may be used (case-insensitively):- ‘
filename
’ - Sets the filename of the MIME part, i.e., the name that is used for display and when (suggesting a name for) saving (purposes).
- ‘
content-description
’ - Associate some descriptive information to the attachment's content, used in favour of the plain filename by some MUAs.
- ‘
content-id
’ - May be used for uniquely identifying MIME entities in several
contexts; this expects a special reference address format as
defined in RFC 2045 and generates a
‘
505
’ upon address content verification failure. - ‘
content-type
’ - Defines the media type/subtype of the part, which is managed automatically, but can be overwritten.
- ‘
content-disposition
’ - Automatically set to the string
‘
attachment
’.
- ‘
attribute-set-at
- This uses the same search mechanism as described for
remove-at
and is otherwise identical toattribute-set
. insert
- Adds the attachment given as the third argument, specified exactly
as documented for the command line option
-a
, and supporting the message number extension as documented for~@
. This reports ‘210
’ upon success, with the index of the new attachment following, ‘505
’ if the given file cannot be opened, ‘506
’ if an on-the-fly performed character set conversion fails, otherwise ‘501
’ is reported; this is also reported if character set conversion is requested but not available. list
- List all attachments via
‘
212
’, or report ‘501
’ if no attachments exist. This command is the default command ofattachment
if no second argument has been given. remove
- This will remove the attachment given as the third argument, and
report ‘
210
’ upon success or ‘501
’ if no such attachment can be found. If there exists any path component in the given argument, then an exact match of the path which has been used to create the attachment is used directly, but if only the basename of that path matches then all attachments are traversed to find an exact match first, and the removal occurs afterwards; if multiple basenames match, a ‘506
’ error occurs. Message attachments are treated as absolute pathnames.If no path component exists in the given argument, then all attachments will be searched for ‘
filename=
’ parameter matches as well as for matches of the basename of the path which has been used when the attachment has been created; multiple matches result in a ‘506
’. remove-at
- This will interpret the third argument as a number and remove the
attachment at that list position (counting from one!), reporting
‘
210
’ upon success or ‘505
’ if the argument is not a number or ‘501
’ if no such attachment exists.
header
- This command allows listing, inspection, and editing of message
headers. Header name case is not normalized, so that case-insensitive
comparison should be used when matching names. The second argument
specifies the subcommand to apply, one of:
insert
- Create a new or an additional instance of the header given in the
third argument, with the header body content as given in the
fourth token. It may return
‘
501
’ if the third argument specifies a free-form header field name that is invalid, or if body content extraction fails to succeed, ‘505
’ if any extracted address does not pass syntax and/or security checks or on Mail namespace violations, and ‘506
’ to indicate prevention of excessing a single-instance header — note that ‘Subject:
’ can be appended to (a space separator will be added automatically first). ‘To:
’, ‘Cc:
’ and ‘Bcc:
’ support the ‘?single
’ modifier to enforce treatment as a single addressee, for example ‘header insert To?single: 'exa, <m@ple>'
’; the word ‘single
’ is optional.‘
210
’ is returned upon success, followed by the name of the header and the list position of the newly inserted instance. The list position is always 1 for single-instance header fields. All free-form header fields are managed in a single list; also see customhdr. list
- Without a third argument a list of all yet existing headers is
given via ‘
210
’; this command is the default command ofheader
if no second argument has been given. A third argument restricts output to the given header only, which may fail with ‘501
’ if no such field is defined. remove
- This will remove all instances of the header given as the third
argument, reporting ‘
210
’ upon success, ‘501
’ if no such header can be found, and ‘505
’ on Mail namespace violations. remove-at
- This will remove from the header given as the third argument the
instance at the list position (counting from one!) given with the
fourth argument, reporting
‘
210
’ upon success or ‘505
’ if the list position argument is not a number or on Mail namespace violations, and ‘501
’ if no such header instance exists. show
- Shows the content of the header given as the third argument.
Dependent on the header type this may respond with
‘
211
’ or ‘212
’; any failure results in ‘501
’.
In compose-mode read-only access to optional pseudo headers in the Mail private namespace is available:
- ‘
Mailx-Command:
’ - The name of the command that generates the message, one of
‘
forward
’, ‘Lreply
’, ‘mail
’, ‘Reply
’, ‘reply
’, ‘resend
’. This pseudo header always exists (in compose-mode). - ‘
Mailx-Raw-To:
’ - ‘
Mailx-Raw-Cc:
’ - ‘
Mailx-Raw-Bcc:
’ - Represent the frozen initial state of these headers before any
transformation (
alias
,alternates
, recipients-in-cc etc.) took place. - ‘
Mailx-Orig-Sender:
’ - ‘
Mailx-Orig-From:
’ - ‘
Mailx-Orig-To:
’ - ‘
Mailx-Orig-Cc:
’ - ‘
Mailx-Orig-Bcc:
’ - The values of said headers of the original message which has been
addressed by any of
reply
,forward
,resend
. The sender field is special as it is filled in with the sole sender according to RFC 5322 rules, it may thus be equal to the from field.
help
,?
- Show an abstract of the above commands via
‘
211
’. version
- This command will print the protocol version via
‘
210
’.
- ‘
~A
- The same as ‘
’.~i
Sign ~a
- The same as ‘
’.~i
sign ~b
name ...- Add the given names to the list of blind carbon copy recipients.
~c
name ...- Add the given names to the list of carbon copy recipients.
~d
- Read the file specified by the
DEAD
variable into the message. ~e
- Invoke the text
EDITOR
on the message collected so far, then return to compose mode.~v
can be used for a more display oriented editor, and~|
| offers a pipe-based editing approach. ~F
messages- Read the named messages into the message being sent, including all message headers and MIME parts, and honouring forward-add-cc as well as forward-inject-head and forward-inject-tail. If no messages are specified, read in the current message, the “dot”.
~f
messages- Read the named messages into the message being sent. If no messages are
specified, read in the current message, the “dot”. Strips
down the list of header fields according to the
‘
forward
’ (with posix: ‘type
’) white- and blacklist selection ofheaderpick
, and honours forward-add-cc as well as forward-inject-head and forward-inject-tail. For MIME multipart messages, only the first displayable part is included. ~H
- In interactive mode, edit the message header fields
‘
From:
’, ‘Reply-To:
’ and ‘Sender:
’ by typing each one in turn and allowing the user to edit the field. The default values for these fields originate from the from, reply-to and sender variables. In non-interactive mode this sets ^ERR-NOTTY. ~h
- In interactive mode, edit the message header fields
‘
To:
’, ‘Cc:
’, ‘Bcc:
’ and ‘Subject:
’ by typing each one in turn and allowing the user to edit the field. In non-interactive mode this sets ^ERR-NOTTY. ~I
variable- Insert the value of the specified variable into the message. The message
remains unaltered if the variable is unset or empty. Any embedded
character sequences ‘
\t
’ horizontal tabulator and ‘\n
’ line feed are expanded in posix mode; otherwise the expansion should occur atset
time ([v15 behaviour may differ] by using the command modifier wysh). ~i
variable- Like
~I
, but appends a newline character. ~M
messages- Read the named messages into the message being sent, indented by indentprefix. If no messages are specified, read the current message, the “dot”. Honours forward-add-cc as well as forward-inject-head and forward-inject-tail.
~m
messages- Read the named messages into the message being sent, indented by
indentprefix. If no messages are specified, read the
current message, the “dot”. Strips down the list of header
fields according to the ‘
type
’ white- and blacklist selection ofheaderpick
. Honours forward-add-cc as well as forward-inject-head and forward-inject-tail. For MIME multipart messages, only the first displayable part is included. ~p
- Display the message collected so far, prefaced by the message header fields and followed by the attachment list, if any.
~Q
- Read in the given / current message(s) using the algorithm of quote (except that is implicitly assumed, even if not set), honouring quote-add-cc.
~q
- Abort the message being sent, copying it to the file specified by the
DEAD
variable if save is set. ~R
filename- Identical to
~r
, but indent each line that has been read by indentprefix. ~r
filename [HERE-delimiter]- Read the named file, object to
Filename
transformations excluding shell globs and variable expansions, into
the message; if filename is the hyphen-minus
‘
-
’ then standard input is used (for pasting, for example). Only in this latter mode HERE-delimiter may be given: if it is data will be read in until the given HERE-delimiter is seen on a line by itself, and encountering EOF is an error; the HERE-delimiter is a required argument in non-interactive mode; if it is single-quote quoted then the pasted content will not be expanded, [v15 behaviour may differ] otherwise a future version of Mail may perform shell-style expansion on the content. ~s
string- Cause the named string to become the current subject field. Newline (NL) and carriage-return (CR) bytes are invalid and will be normalized to space (SP) characters.
~t
name ...- Add the given name(s) to the direct recipient list.
~U
messages- Read in the given / current message(s) excluding all headers, indented by indentprefix. Honours forward-add-cc as well as forward-inject-head and forward-inject-tail.
~u
messages- Read in the given / current message(s), excluding all headers. Honours forward-add-cc as well as forward-inject-head and forward-inject-tail.
~v
- Invoke the
VISUAL
editor on the message collected so far, then return to compose mode.~e
can be used for a less display oriented editor, and~|
| offers a pipe-based editing approach. ~w
filename- Write the message onto the named file, which is object to the usual Filename transformations. If the file exists, the message is appended to it.
~x
- Same as
~q
, except that the message is not saved at all.
INTERNAL VARIABLES
Internal Mail variables are controlled via the
set
and unset
commands;
prefixing a variable name with the string
‘no
’ and calling
set
has the same effect as using
unset
: ‘unset
crt
’ and ‘set nocrt
’ do
the same thing. varshow
will give more insight on
the given variable(s), and set
, when called without
arguments, will show a listing of all variables. Both commands support a
more verbose listing mode. Some well-known variables
will also become inherited from the program
ENVIRONMENT implicitly, others can be
imported explicitly with the command environ
and
henceforth share said properties.
Two different kinds of internal variables exist, and both of which can also form chains. There are boolean variables, which can only be in one of the two states “set” and “unset”, and value variables with a(n optional) string value. For the latter proper quoting is necessary upon assignment time, the introduction of the section COMMANDS documents the supported quoting rules.
? wysh set one=val\ 1 two="val 2" \ three='val "3"' four=$'val \'4\''; \ varshow one two three four; \ unset one two three four
Dependent upon the actual option string values may become
interpreted as colour names, command specifications, normal text, etc. They
may be treated as numbers, in which case decimal values are expected if so
documented, but otherwise any numeric format and base that is valid and
understood by the vexpr
command may be used,
too.
There also exists a special kind of string value, the
“boolean string”, which must either be a decimal integer (in
which case ‘0
’ is false and
‘1
’ and any other value is true) or
any of the (case-insensitive) strings
‘off
’,
‘no
’,
‘n
’ and
‘false
’ for a false boolean and
‘on
’,
‘yes
’,
‘y
’ and
‘true
’ for a true boolean; a special
kind of boolean string is the “quadoption”: it can optionally
be prefixed with the (case-insensitive) term
‘ask-
’, as in
‘ask-yes
’; in interactive mode the
user will be prompted, otherwise the actual boolean is used.
Variable chains extend a plain
‘variable
’ with
‘variable-HOST
’ and
‘variable-USER@HOST
’ variants. Here
‘HOST
’ will be converted to all
lowercase when looked up (but not when the variable is set or unset!),
[Option]ally IDNA converted, and indeed means
‘server:port
’ if a
‘port
’ had been specified in the
contextual Uniform Resource Locator URL, see
On URL syntax and
credential lookup. Even though this mechanism is based on URLs no URL
percent encoding may be applied to neither of
‘USER
’ nor
‘HOST
’, variable chains need to be
specified using raw data; the mentioned section contains examples. Variables
which support chains are explicitly documented as such, and Mail treats the
base name of any such variable special, meaning that users should not create
custom names like ‘variable-xyz
’ in
order to avoid false classifications and treatment of such variables.
Initial settings
The standard POSIX 2008/Cor 2-2016 mandates the following initial
variable settings: noallnet,
noappend, asksub,
noaskbcc, noautoprint,
nobang, nocmd,
nocrt, nodebug,
nodot, escape set to
‘~
’, noflipr,
nofolder, header,
nohold, noignore,
noignoreeof, nokeep,
nokeepsave, nometoo,
nooutfolder, nopage,
prompt set to
‘?
’,
noquiet, norecord,
save, nosendwait,
noshowto, noSign,
nosign, toplines set to
‘5
’.
However, Mail has built-in some initial (and some default)
settings which (may) diverge, others may become adjusted by one of the
Resource files. Displaying the
former is accomplished via set
:
‘$ mail -:/ -v -Xset -Xx
’. In general
this implementation sets (and has extended the meaning of)
sendwait, and does not support the
noonehop variable – use command line options or
mta-arguments to pass options through to a
mta. The default global resource file sets, among
others, the variables hold, keep
and keepsave, establishes a default
headerpick
selection etc., and should thus be taken
into account.
Variables
- ?
- (Read-only) The exit status of the last command, or the
return
value of the macrocall
ed last. This status has a meaning in the state machine: in conjunction with errexit any non-0 exit status will cause a program exit, and in posix mode any error while loading (any of the) resource files will have the same effect.ignerr
, one of the Command modifiers, can be used to instruct the state machine to ignore errors. - !
- (Read-only) The current error number
(errno(3)), which is set after an
error occurred; it is also available via ^ERR, and
the error name and documentation string can be queried via
^ERRNAME and ^ERRDOC. [v15
behaviour may differ] This machinery is new and the error number is only
really usable if a command explicitly states that it manages the variable
!, for others errno will be used in case of errors,
or ^ERR-INVAL if that is 0: it thus may or may not
reflect the real error. The error number may be set with the command
return
. - ^
- (Read-only) This is a multiplexer variable which performs dynamic
expansion of the requested state or condition, of which there are:
- ^ERR, ^ERRDOC, ^ERRNAME
- The number, documentation, and name of the current
errno(3), respectively, which
is usually set after an error occurred. The documentation is an
[Option], the name is used if not available. [v15 behaviour may
differ] This machinery is new and is usually reliable only if a
command explicitly states that it manages the variable
!, which is effectively identical to
^ERR. Each of those variables can be suffixed
with a hyphen minus followed by a name or number, in which case the
expansion refers to the given error. Note this is a direct mapping of
(a subset of) the system error values:
define work { eval echo \$1: \$^ERR-$1:\ \$^ERRNAME-$1: \$^ERRDOC-$1 vput vexpr i + "$1" 1 if [ $i -lt 16 ] \xcall work $i end } call work 0
- ^ERRQUEUE-COUNT, ^ERRQUEUE-EXISTS
- The number of messages in the [Option]al queue of
errors
, and a string indicating queue state: empty or (translated) “ERROR”. Always 0 and the empty string, respectively, unless features includes ‘,+errors,
’.
- *
- (Read-only) Expands all positional parameters (see 1), separated by the first character of the value of ifs. [v15 behaviour may differ] The special semantics of the equally named special parameter of the sh(1) are not yet supported.
- @
- (Read-only) Expands all positional parameters (see 1), separated by a space character. If placed in double quotation marks, each positional parameter is properly quoted to expand to a single parameter again.
- #
- (Read-only) Expands to the number of positional parameters, i.e., the size of the positional parameter stack in decimal.
- 0
- (Read-only) Inside the scope of a
define
d andcall
ed macro this expands to the name of the calling macro, or to the empty string if the macro is running from top-level. For the [Option]al regular expression search and replace operator ofvexpr
this expands to the entire matching expression. It represents the program name in global context. - 1
- (Read-only) Access of the positional parameter stack. All further
parameters can be accessed with this syntax, too,
‘
2
’, ‘3
’ etc.; positional parameters can be shifted off the stack by callingshift
. The parameter stack contains, for example, the arguments of acall
eddefine
d macro, the matching groups of the [Option]al regular expression search and replace expression ofvexpr
, and can be explicitly created or overwritten with the commandvpospar
. - account
- (Read-only) Is set to the active
account
. - add-file-recipients
- (Boolean) When file or pipe recipients have been specified, mention them in the corresponding address fields of the message instead of silently stripping them from their recipient list. By default such addressees are not mentioned.
- allnet
- (Boolean) Causes only the local part to be evaluated when comparing addresses.
- append
- (Boolean) Causes messages saved in the
secondary mailbox
MBOX
to be appended to the end rather than prepended. This should always be set. - askatend
- (Boolean) Causes the prompts for
‘
Cc:
’ and ‘Bcc:
’ lists to appear after the message has been edited. - askattach
- (Boolean) If set, Mail asks an interactive user for files to attach at the end of each message; An empty line finalizes the list.
- askcc
- (Boolean) Causes the interactive user to be prompted for carbon copy recipients (at the end of each message if askatend or bsdcompat are set).
- askbcc
- (Boolean) Causes the interactive user to be prompted for blind carbon copy recipients (at the end of each message if askatend or bsdcompat are set).
- asksend
- (Boolean) Causes the interactive user to be prompted for confirmation to send the message or reenter compose mode after having been shown a preliminary envelope summary.
- asksign
- (Boolean)[Option] Causes the interactive user to be prompted if the message is to be signed at the end of each message. The smime-sign variable is ignored when this variable is set.
- asksub
- (Boolean) Causes Mail to prompt the interactive user for the subject upon entering compose mode unless a subject already exists.
- attrlist
- A sequence of characters to display in the
‘
attribute
’ column of the headline as shown in the display ofheaders
; each for one type of messages (see Message states), with the default being ‘NUROSPMFAT+-$~
’ or ‘NU *HMFAT+-$~
’ if the bsdflags variable is set, in the following order:- ‘
N
’ - new.
- ‘
U
’ - unread but old.
- ‘
R
’ - new but read.
- ‘
O
’ - read and old.
- ‘
S
’ - saved.
- ‘
P
’ - preserved.
- ‘
M
’ - mboxed.
- ‘
F
’ - flagged.
- ‘
A
’ - answered.
- ‘
T
’ - draft.
- ‘
+
’ - [v15 behaviour may differ] start of a (collapsed) thread in threaded
mode (see autosort,
thread
); - ‘
-
’ - [v15 behaviour may differ] an uncollapsed thread in threaded mode;
only used in conjunction with
-L
. - ‘
$
’ - classified as spam.
- ‘
~
’ - classified as possible spam.
- ‘
- autobcc
- Specifies a list of recipients to which a blind carbon copy of each outgoing message will be sent automatically.
- autocc
- Specifies a list of recipients to which a carbon copy of each outgoing message will be sent automatically.
- autocollapse
- (Boolean) Causes threads to be collapsed automatically when .Ql thread Ns
ed
sort
mode is entered (see thecollapse
command). - autoprint
- (Boolean) Enable automatic
type
ing of a(n existing) “successive” message afterdelete
andundelete
commands: the message that becomes the new “dot” is shown automatically, as viadp
ordt
. - autosort
- Causes sorted mode (see the
sort
command) to be entered automatically with the value of this variable as sorting method when a folder is opened, for example ‘set autosort=thread
’. - bang
- (Boolean) Enables the substitution of all not (reverse-solidus) escaped
exclamation mark ‘
!
’ characters by the contents of the last executed command for the!
shell escape command and~!
, one of the compose mode COMMAND ESCAPES. If this variable is not set no reverse solidus stripping is performed. - bind-timeout
- [Obsolete] Predecessor of bind-inter-byte-timeout. [v15 behaviour may differ] Setting this automatically sets the successor.
- bind-inter-byte-timeout
- [Option] Terminals may generate multi-byte sequences for special function
keys, for example, but these sequences may not become read as a unit. And
multi-byte sequences can be defined freely via
bind
. This variable specifies the timeout in milliseconds that the MLE (see On terminal control and line editor) waits for more bytes to arrive unless it considers a sequence “complete”. The default is 200, the maximum is about 10 seconds. In the following example the comments state which sequences are affected by this timeout:? bind base abc echo 0 # abc ? bind base ab,c echo 1 # ab ? bind base abc,d echo 2 # abc ? bind base ac,d echo 3 # ac ? bind base a,b,c echo 4 ? bind base a,b,c,d echo 5 ? bind base a,b,cc,dd echo 6 # cc and dd
- bind-inter-key-timeout
- [Option] Multi-key
bind
sequences do not time out by default. If this variable is set, then the current key sequence is forcefully terminated once the timeout (in milliseconds) triggers. The value should be (maybe significantly) larger than bind-inter-byte-timeout, but may not excess the maximum, too. - bsdcompat
- (Boolean) Sets some cosmetical features to traditional BSD style; has the
same affect as setting askatend and all other
variables prefixed with ‘
bsd
’; it also changes the behaviour of emptystart (which does not exist in BSD). - bsdflags
- (Boolean) Changes the letters shown in the first column of a header summary to traditional BSD style.
- bsdheadline
- (Boolean) Changes the display of columns in a header summary to traditional BSD style.
- bsdmsgs
- (Boolean) Changes some informational messages to traditional BSD style.
- bsdorder
- (Boolean) Causes the ‘
Subject:
’ field to appear immediately after the ‘To:
’ field in message headers and with the~h
COMMAND ESCAPES. - build-cc, build-ld, build-os, build-rest
- (Read-only) The build environment, including the compiler, the linker, the
operating system Mail has been build for, usually taken from
uname(1) via
‘
uname -s
’, and then lowercased, as well as all the possibly interesting rest of the configuration and build environment. This information is also available in the verbose output of the commandversion
. - charset-7bit
- The value that should appear in the
‘
charset=
’ parameter of ‘Content-Type:
’ MIME header fields when no character set conversion of the message data was performed. This defaults to US-ASCII, and the chosen character set should be US-ASCII compatible. - charset-8bit
- [Option] The default 8-bit character set that is used as an implicit last member of the variable sendcharsets. This defaults to UTF-8 if character set conversion capabilities are available, and to ISO-8859-1 otherwise (unless the operating system environment is known to always and exclusively support UTF-8 locales), in which case the only supported character set is ttycharset and this variable is effectively ignored.
- charset-unknown-8bit
- [Option] RFC 1428 specifies conditions when internet mail gateways shall
“upgrade” the content of a mail message by using a character
set with the name ‘
unknown-8bit
’. Because of the unclassified nature of this character set Mail will not be capable to convert this character set to any other character set. If this variable is set any message part which uses the character set ‘unknown-8bit
’ is assumed to really be in the character set given in the value, otherwise the (final) value of charset-8bit is used for this purpose.This variable will also be taken into account if a MIME type (see The mime.types files) of a MIME message part that uses the ‘
binary
’ character set is forcefully treated as text. - cmd
- The default value for the
pipe
command. - colour-disable
- (Boolean)[Option] Forcefully disable usage of colours. Also see the section Coloured display.
- colour-pager
- (Boolean)[Option] Whether colour shall be used for output that is paged
through
PAGER
. Note that pagers may need special command line options, for example less(1) requires the option-R
and lv(1) the option-c
in order to support colours. Often doing manual adjustments is unnecessary since Mail may perform adjustments dependent on the value of the environment variablePAGER
(see there for more). - contact-mail, contact-web
- (Read-only) Addresses for contact per email and web, respectively, for bug
reports, suggestions, or anything else regarding Mail. The former can be
used directly: ‘
?
’.eval
mail
$contact-mail - content-description-forwarded-message, content-description-quote-attachment, content-description-smime-message, content-description-smime-signature
- [Option](partially) Strings which will be placed in according
‘
Content-Description:
’ headers if non-empty. They all have default values, for example ‘Forwarded message
’. - crt
- In a(n interactive) terminal session, then if this valued variable is set
it will be used as a threshold to determine how many lines the given
output has to span before it will be displayed via the configured
PAGER
; Usage of thePAGER
can be forced by setting this to the value ‘0
’, setting it without a value will deduce the current height of the terminal screen to compute the threshold (seeLINES
, screen and stty(1)). [v15 behaviour may differ] At the moment this uses the count of lines of the message in wire format, which, dependent on the mime-encoding of the message, is unrelated to the number of display lines. (The software is old and historically the relation was a given thing.) - customhdr
- Define a set of custom headers to be injected into newly composed or
forwarded messages. A custom header consists of the field name followed by
a colon ‘
:
’ and the field content body. Standard header field names cannot be overwritten by a custom header, with the exception of ‘Comments:
’ and ‘Keywords:
’. Different to the command line option-C
the variable value is interpreted as a comma-separated list of custom headers: to include commas in header bodies they need to become escaped with reverse solidus ‘\
’. Headers can be managed more freely in Compose mode via~^
.? set customhdr='Hdr1: Body1-1\, Body1-2, Hdr2: Body2'
- datefield
- Controls the appearance of the ‘
%d
’ date and time format specification of the headline variable, that is used, for example, when viewing the summary ofheaders
. If unset, then the local receiving date is used and displayed unformatted, otherwise the message sending ‘Date:
’. It is possible to assign a strftime(3) format string and control formatting, but embedding newlines via the ‘%n
’ format is not supported, and will result in display errors. The default is ‘%Y-%m-%d %H:%M
’, and also see datefield-markout-older. - datefield-markout-older
- Only used in conjunction with datefield. Can be used
to create a visible distinction of messages dated more than a day in the
future, or older than six months, a concept comparable to the
-l
option of the POSIX utility ls(1). If set to the empty string, then the plain month, day and year of the ‘Date:
’ will be displayed, but a strftime(3) format string to control formatting can be assigned. The default is ‘%Y-%m-%d
’. - debug
- (Boolean) (Almost) Enter a debug-only sandbox mode which generates many log messages, disables the actual delivery of messages, and also implies norecord as well as nosave. Also see verbose.
- disposition-notification-send
- (Boolean)[Option] Emit a
‘
Disposition-Notification-To:
’ header (RFC 3798) with the message. This requires the from variable to be set. - dot
- (Boolean) When dot is set, a period
‘
.
’ on a line by itself during message input in (interactive or batch-#
) Compose mode will be treated as end-of-message (in addition to the normal end-of-file condition). This behaviour is implied in posix mode with a set ignoreeof. - dotlock-disable
- (Boolean)[Option] Disable creation of dotlock files for MBOX databases.
- dotlock-ignore-error
- [Obsolete](Boolean)[Option] Ignore failures when creating dotlock files. Please use dotlock-disable instead.
- editalong
- If this variable is set then the editor is started automatically when a
message is composed in interactive mode. If the value starts with the
letter ‘
v
’ then this acts as if~v
, otherwise as if~e
(see COMMAND ESCAPES) had been specified. The editheaders variable is implied for this automatically spawned editor session. - editheaders
- (Boolean) When a message is edited while being composed, its header is included in the editable text.
- emptystart
- (Boolean) When entering interactive mode Mail normally writes “No mail for user” and exits immediately if a mailbox is empty or does not exist. If this variable is set Mail starts even with an empty or non-existent mailbox (the latter behaviour furtherly depends upon bsdcompat, though).
- errexit
- (Boolean) Let each command with a non-0 exit status, including every
call
ed macro whichreturn
s a non-0 status, cause a program exit unless prefixed byignerr
(see Command modifiers). This also affects COMMAND ESCAPES, but which use a different modifier for ignoring the error. Please refer to the variable ? for more on this topic. - errors-limit
- [Option] Maximum number of entries in the
errors
queue. - escape
- The first character of this value defines the escape character for
COMMAND ESCAPES in
Compose mode. The default value is
the character tilde ‘
~
’. If set to the empty string, command escapes are disabled. - expandaddr
- If unset only user name and email address recipients are allowed
On sending
mail, and non-interactive mode. If set without value all possible
recipient types will be accepted. A value is parsed as a comma-separated
list of case-insensitive strings, and if that contains
‘
restrict
’ behaviour equals the former except when in interactive mode or if COMMAND ESCAPES were enabled via-~
or-#
, in which case it equals the latter, allowing all address types. ‘restrict
’ really acts like ‘restrict,-all,+name,+addr
’, so care for ordering issues must be taken.Recipient types can be added and removed with a plus sign ‘
+
’ or hyphen-minus ‘-
’ prefix, respectively. By default invalid or disallowed types are filtered out and cause a warning, hard send errors need to be enforced by including ‘fail
’. The value ‘all
’ covers all types, ‘fcc
’ whitelists ‘Fcc:
’ header targets regardless of other settings, ‘file
’ file targets (it includes ‘fcc
’), ‘pipe
’ command pipeline targets, ‘name
’ user names still unexpanded afteralias
and mta-aliases processing and thus left for expansion by the mta (invalid for the built-in SMTP one), and ‘addr
’ network addresses. Targets are interpreted in the given order, so that ‘restrict,fail,+file,-all,+addr
’ will cause hard errors for any non-network address recipient address unless running interactively or having been started with the option-~
or-#
; in the latter case(s) any type may be used.User name receivers addressing valid local users can be expanded to fully qualified network addresses (also see hostname) by including ‘
nametoaddr
’ in the list. Historically invalid recipients were stripped off without causing errors, this can be changed by making ‘failinvaddr
’ an entry of the list (it really acts like ‘failinvaddr,+addr
’). Likewise, ‘domaincheck
’ (really ‘domaincheck,+addr
’) compares address domain names against a whitelist and strips off (‘fail
’ for hard errors) addressees which fail this test; the domain name ‘localhost
’ and the non-empty value of hostname (the real hostname otherwise) are always whitelisted, expandaddr-domaincheck can be set to extend this list. Finally some address providers (for example-b
,-c
and all other command line recipients) will be evaluated as if specified within dollar-single-quotes (see Shell-style argument quoting) if the value list contains the string ‘shquote
’. - expandaddr-domaincheck
- Can be set to a comma-separated list of domain names which should be
whitelisted for the evaluation of the
‘
domaincheck
’ mode of expandaddr. IDNA encoding is not automatically performed,addrcodec
can be used to prepare the domain (of an address). - expandargv
- Unless this variable is set additional mta
(Mail-Transfer-Agent) arguments from the command line, as can be given
after a
--
separator, results in a program termination with failure status. The same can be accomplished by using the special (case-insensitive) value ‘fail
’. A lesser strict variant is the otherwise identical ‘restrict
’, which does accept such arguments in interactive mode, or if tilde commands were enabled explicitly by using one of the command line options-~
or-#
. The empty value will allow unconditional usage. - features
- (Read-only) String giving a list of optional features. Features are
preceded with a plus sign ‘
+
’ if they are available, with a hyphen-minus ‘-
’ otherwise. To ease substring matching the string starts and ends with a comma. The output of the commandversion
includes this information in a more pleasant output. - flipr
- (Boolean) This setting reverses the meanings of a set of reply commands,
turning the lowercase variants, which by default address all recipients
included in the header of a message (
reply
,respond
,followup
) into the uppercase variants, which by default address the sender only (Reply
,Respond
,Followup
) and vice versa. - folder
- The default path under which mailboxes are to be saved: filenames that
begin with the plus sign ‘
+
’ will have the plus sign replaced with the value of this variable if set, otherwise the plus sign will remain unchanged when doing Filename transformations; also seefolder
for more on this topic, and know about standard imposed implications of outfolder. The value supports a subset of transformations itself, and if the non-empty value does not start with a solidus ‘/
’, then the value ofHOME
will be prefixed automatically. Once the actual value is evaluated first, the internal variable folder-resolved will be updated for caching purposes. - folder-hook-FOLDER, folder-hook
- Names a
define
d macro which will be called whenever afolder
is opened. The macro will also be invoked when new mail arrives, but message lists for commands executed from the macro only include newly arrived messages then.localopts
are activated by default in a folder hook, causing the covered settings to be reverted once the folder is left again.The specialized form will override the generic one if ‘
FOLDER
’ matches the file that is opened. Unlike other folder specifications, the fully expanded name of a folder, without metacharacters, is used to avoid ambiguities. However, if the mailbox resides under folder then the usual ‘+
’ specification is tried in addition, so that if folder is “mail” (and thus relative to the user's home directory) then /home/usr1/mail/sent will be tried as ‘folder-hook-/home/usr1/mail/sent
’ first, but then followed by ‘folder-hook-+sent
’. - folder-resolved
- (Read-only) Set to the fully resolved path of folder once that evaluation has occurred; rather internal.
- followup-to
- (Boolean) Controls whether a
‘
Mail-Followup-To:
’ header is generated when sending messages to known mailing lists. The user as determined via from (or, if that contains multiple addresses, sender) will be placed in there if any list addressee is not a subscribed list. Also see followup-to-honour and the commandsmlist
,mlsubscribe
,reply
andLreply
. - followup-to-add-cc
- (Boolean) Controls whether the user will be added to the messages'
‘
Cc:
’ list in addition to placing an entry in ‘Mail-Followup-To:
’ (see followup-to). - followup-to-honour
- Controls whether a
‘
Mail-Followup-To:
’ header is honoured when group-replying to a message viareply
orLreply
. This is a quadoption; if set without a value it defaults to “yes”, and see followup-to. - forward-add-cc
- (Boolean) Whether senders of messages forwarded via
~F
,~f
,~m
,~U
or~u
shall be made members of the carbon copies ‘Cc:
’ list. - forward-as-attachment
- (Boolean) Original messages are normally sent as inline text with the
forward
command, and only the first part of a multipart message is included. With this setting enabled messages are sent as unmodified MIME ‘message/rfc822
’ attachments with all of their parts included. - forward-inject-head, forward-inject-tail
- The strings to put before and after the text of a message with the
forward
command, respectively. The former defaults to ‘-------- Original Message --------\n
’. Special format directives in these strings will be expanded if possible, and if so configured the output will be folded according to quote-fold; for more please refer to quote-inject-head. Injections will not be performed byforward
if the variable forward-as-attachment is set — the COMMAND ESCAPES~F
,~f
,~M
,~m
,~U
,~u
always inject. - from
- The address (or a list of addresses) to put into the
‘
From:
’ field of the message header, quoting RFC 5322: the author(s) of the message, that is, the mailbox(es) of the person(s) or system(s) responsible for the writing of the message. According to that RFC setting the sender variable is required if from contains more than one address. [v15 behaviour may differ] Please expect automatic management of the from and sender relationship. Dependent on the context these addresses are handled as if they were in the list ofalternates
.If a file-based MTA is used, then from (or, if that contains multiple addresses, sender) can nonetheless be used as the envelope sender address at the MTA protocol level (the RFC 5321 reverse-path), either via the
-r
command line option (without argument; see there for more), or by setting r-option-implicit.If the machine's hostname is not valid at the Internet (for example at a dialup machine), then either this variable or hostname ([v15-compat] a SMTP-based mta adds even more fine-tuning capabilities with smtp-hostname) have to be set: if so the message and MIME part related unique ID fields ‘
Message-ID:
’ and ‘Content-ID:
’ will be created (except when disallowed by message-id-disable or stealthmua). - fullnames
- (Boolean) Due to historical reasons comments and name parts of email addresses are removed by default when sending mail, replying to or forwarding a message. If this variable is set such stripping is not performed.
- fwdheading
- [Obsolete] Predecessor of forward-inject-head.
- header
- (Boolean) Causes the header summary to be written at startup and after
commands that affect the number of messages or the order of messages in
the current
folder
. Unless in posix mode a header summary will also be displayed on folder changes. The command line option-N
can be used to set noheader. - headline
- A format string to use for the summary of
headers
. Format specifiers in the given string start with a percent sign ‘%
’ and may be followed by an optional decimal number indicating the field width — if that is negative, the field is to be left-aligned. Names and addresses are subject to modifications according to showname and showto. Valid format specifiers are:- ‘
%%
’ - A plain percent sign.
- ‘
%>
’ - “Dotmark”: a space character but for the current message
(“dot”), for which it expands to
‘
>
’ (dependent on headline-plain). - ‘
%<
’ - “Dotmark”: a space character but for the current message
(“dot”), for which it expands to
‘
<
’ (dependent on headline-plain). - ‘
%$
’ - [Option] The spam score of the message, as has been classified via the
command
spamrate
. Shows only a replacement character if there is no spam support. - ‘
%a
’ - Message attribute character (status flag); the actual content can be adjusted by setting attrlist.
- ‘
%d
’ - The date found in the ‘
Date:
’ header of the message when datefield is set (the default), otherwise the date when the message was received. Formatting can be controlled by assigning a strftime(3) format string to datefield (and datefield-markout-older). - ‘
%e
’ - The indenting level in
‘
thread
’edsort
mode. - ‘
%f
’ - The address of the message sender.
- ‘
%i
’ - The message thread tree structure. (Note that this format does not support a field width, and honours headline-plain.)
- ‘
%L
’ - Mailing list status: is the addressee of the message a known
‘
l
’ (mlist
) or ‘L
’mlsubscribe
d mailing list? The letter ‘P
’ announces the presence of a RFC 2369 ‘List-Post:
’ header, which makes a message a valuable target ofLreply
. - ‘
%l
’ - The number of lines of the message, if available.
- ‘
%m
’ - Message number.
- ‘
%o
’ - The number of octets (bytes) in the message, if available.
- ‘
%S
’ - Message subject (if any) in double quotes.
- ‘
%s
’ - Message subject (if any).
- ‘
%t
’ - The position in threaded/sorted order.
- ‘
%U
’ - The value 0 except in an IMAP mailbox, where it expands to the UID of the message.
The default is ‘
%>%a%m %-18f %16d %4l/%-5o %i%-s
’, or ‘%>%a%m %20-f %16d %3l/%-5o %i%-S
’ if bsdcompat is set. Also see attrlist, headline-plain and headline-bidi. - ‘
- headline-bidi
- Bidirectional text requires special treatment when displaying headers,
because numbers (in dates or for file sizes etc.) will not affect the
current text direction, in effect resulting in ugly line layouts when
arabic or other right-to-left text is to be displayed. On the other hand
only a minority of terminals is capable to correctly handle direction
changes, so that user interaction is necessary for acceptable results.
Note that extended host system support is required nonetheless, e.g.,
detection of the terminal character set is one precondition; and this
feature only works in an Unicode (i.e., UTF-8) locale.
In general setting this variable will cause Mail to encapsulate text fields that may occur when displaying headline (and some other fields, like dynamic expansions in prompt) with special Unicode control sequences; it is possible to fine-tune the terminal support level by assigning a value: no value (or any value other than ‘
1
’, ‘2
’ and ‘3
’) will make Mail assume that the terminal is capable to properly deal with Unicode version 6.3, in which case text is embedded in a pair of U+2068 (FIRST STRONG ISOLATE) and U+2069 (POP DIRECTIONAL ISOLATE) characters. In addition no space on the line is reserved for these characters.Weaker support is chosen by using the value ‘
1
’ (Unicode 6.3, but reserve the room of two spaces for writing the control sequences onto the line). The values ‘2
’ and ‘3
’ select Unicode 1.1 support (U+200E, LEFT-TO-RIGHT MARK); the latter again reserves room for two spaces in addition. - headline-plain
- (Boolean) On Unicode (UTF-8) aware terminals enhanced graphical symbols are used by default for certain entries of headline. If this variable is set only basic US-ASCII symbols will be used.
- history-file
- [Option] The (expandable) location of a permanent
history
file for the MLE line editor (On terminal control and line editor). Also see history-size. - history-gabby
- [Option] Add more entries to the MLE
history
as is normally done. A comma-separated list of case-insensitive strings can be used to fine-tune which gabby entries shall be allowed. If it contains ‘errors
’, erroneous commands will also be added. ‘all
’ adds all optional entries, and is the fallback chattiness identifier of on-history-addition. - history-gabby-persist
- (Boolean)[Option] The history-gabby entries will not be saved in persistent storage unless this variable is set. The knowledge of whether a persistent entry was gabby is not lost. Also see history-file.
- history-size
- [Option] Setting this variable imposes a limit on the number of concurrent
history
entries. If set to the value 0 then no further history entries will be added, and loading and incorporation of the history-file upon program startup can also be suppressed by doing this. Runtime changes will not be reflected before thehistory
is saved or loaded (again). - hold
- (Boolean) This setting controls whether messages are held in the system inbox, and it is set by default.
- hostname
- Used instead of the value obtained from
uname(3) and
getaddrinfo(3) as the
hostname when expanding local addresses, for example in
‘
From:
’ (also see On sending mail, and non-interactive mode, for expansion of addresses that have a valid user-, but no domain name in angle brackets). If either of from or this variable is set the message and MIME part related unique ID fields ‘Message-ID:
’ and ‘Content-ID:
’ will be created (except when disallowed by message-id-disable or stealthmua). If the [Option]al IDNA support is available (see idna-disable) variable assignment is aborted when a necessary conversion fails.Setting it to the empty string will cause the normal hostname to be used, but nonetheless enables creation of said ID fields. [v15-compat] in conjunction with the built-in SMTP mta smtp-hostname also influences the results: one should produce some test messages with the desired combination of hostname, and/or from, sender etc. first.
- idna-disable
- (Boolean)[Option] Can be used to turn off the automatic conversion of domain names according to the rules of IDNA (internationalized domain names for applications). Since the IDNA code assumes that domain names are specified with the ttycharset character set, an UTF-8 locale charset is required to represent all possible international domain names (before conversion, that is).
- ifs
- The input field separator that is used ([v15 behaviour may differ] by some
functions) to determine where to split input data.
- 1.
- Unsetting is treated as assigning the default value,
‘
\t\n
’. - 2.
- If set to the empty value, no field splitting will be performed.
- 3.
- If set to a non-empty value, all whitespace characters are extracted and assigned to the variable ifs-ws.
- a.
- ifs-ws will be ignored at the beginning and end of input. Diverging from POSIX shells default whitespace is removed in addition, which is owed to the entirely different line content extraction rules.
- b.
- Each occurrence of a character of ifs will cause field-splitting, any adjacent ifs-ws characters will be skipped.
- ifs-ws
- (Read-only) Automatically deduced from the whitespace characters in ifs.
- ignore
- (Boolean) Ignore interrupt signals from the terminal while entering
messages; instead echo them as ‘
@
’ characters and discard the current line. - ignoreeof
- (Boolean) Ignore end-of-file conditions
(‘
control-D
’) in Compose mode on message input and in interactive command input. If set an interactive command input session can only be left by explicitly using one of the commandsexit
andquit
, and message input in compose mode can only be terminated by entering a period ‘.
’ on a line by itself or by using the~.
COMMAND ESCAPES; Setting this implies the behaviour that dot describes in posix mode. - inbox
- If this is set to a non-empty string it will specify the user's
primary system mailbox,
overriding
MAIL
and the system-dependent default, and (thus) be used to replace ‘%
’ when doing Filename transformations; also seefolder
for more on this topic. The value supports a subset of transformations itself. - indentprefix
- String used by the
~m
,~M
and~R
COMMAND ESCAPES and by the quote option for indenting messages, in place of the POSIX mandated default tabulator character ‘\t
’. Also see quote-chars. - keep
- (Boolean) If set, an empty primary system mailbox file is not removed. Note that, in conjunction with posix mode any empty file will be removed unless this variable is set. This may improve the interoperability with other mail user agents when using a common folder directory, and prevents malicious users from creating fake mailboxes in a world-writable spool directory. [v15 behaviour may differ] Only local regular (MBOX) files are covered, Maildir and other mailbox types will never be removed, even if empty.
- keep-content-length
- (Boolean) When (editing messages and) writing MBOX mailbox files Mail can
be told to keep the
‘
Content-Length:
’ and ‘Lines:
’ header fields that some MUAs generate by setting this variable. Since Mail does neither use nor update these non-standardized header fields (which in itself shows one of their conceptual problems), stripping them should increase interoperability in between MUAs that work with with same mailbox files. Note that, if this is not set but writebackedited, as below, is, a possibly performed automatic stripping of these header fields already marks the message as being modified. [v15 behaviour may differ] At some future time Mail will be capable to rewrite and apply an mime-encoding to modified messages, and then those fields will be stripped silently. - keepsave
- (Boolean) When a message is saved it is usually discarded from the originating folder when Mail is quit. This setting causes all saved message to be retained.
- line-editor-cpl-word-breaks
- [Option] List of bytes which are used by the
mle-complete
tabulator completion to decide where word boundaries exist, by default ‘"'@=;|:
’ [v15 behaviour may differ] This mechanism is yet restricted. - line-editor-disable
- (Boolean) Turn off any line editing capabilities (from Mails POW, see On terminal control and line editor for more).
- line-editor-no-defaults
- (Boolean)[Option] Do not establish any default key binding.
- log-prefix
- Error log message prefix string (‘
mail:
’). - mailbox-display
- (Read-only) The name of the current mailbox
(
folder
), possibly abbreviated for display purposes. - mailbox-resolved
- (Read-only) The fully resolved path of the current mailbox.
- mailcap-disable
- (Boolean)[Option] Turn off consideration of MIME type handlers from, and implicit loading of The Mailcap files.
- mailx-extra-rc
- An additional startup file that is loaded as the last of the Resource files. Use this file for commands that are not understood by other POSIX mailx(1) implementations, i.e., mostly anything which is not covered by Initial settings.
- markanswered
- (Boolean) When a message is replied to and this variable is set, it is
marked as having been
answered
. See the section Message states. - mbox-fcc-and-pcc
- (Boolean) By default all file and pipe message receivers (see
expandaddr) will be fed valid MBOX database entry
message data (see
folder
, mbox-rfc4155), and existing file targets will become extended in compliance to RFC 4155. If this variable is unset then a plain standalone RFC 5322 message will be written, and existing file targets will be overwritten. - mbox-rfc4155
- (Boolean) When opening MBOX mailbox databases, and in order to achieve
compatibility with old software, the very tolerant POSIX standard rules
for detecting message boundaries (so-called
‘
From_
’ lines) are used instead of the stricter rules from the standard RFC 4155. This behaviour can be switched by setting this variable.This may temporarily be handy when Mail complains about invalid ‘
From_
’ lines when opening a MBOX: in this case setting this variable and re-opening the mailbox in question may correct the result. If so, copying the entire mailbox to some other file, as in ‘copy * SOME-FILE
’, will perform proper, all-compatible ‘From_
’ quoting for all detected messages, resulting in a valid MBOX mailbox. ([v15 behaviour may differ] The better and non-destructive approach is to re-encode invalid messages, as if it would be created anew, instead of mangling the ‘From_
’ lines; this requires the structural code changes of the v15 rewrite.) Finally the variable can be unset again:define mboxfix { localopts yes; wysh set mbox-rfc4155;\ wysh File "${1}"; copy * "${2}" } call mboxfix /tmp/bad.mbox /tmp/good.mbox
- memdebug
- (Boolean) Internal development variable. (Keeps memory debug enabled even if debug is not set.)
- message-id-disable
- (Boolean) By setting this variable the generation of
‘
Message-ID:
’ and ‘Content-ID:
’ message and MIME part headers can be completely suppressed, effectively leaving this task up to the mta (Mail-Transfer-Agent) or the SMTP server. Note that according to RFC 5321 a SMTP server is not required to add this field by itself, so it should be ensured that it accepts messages without ‘Message-ID
’. - message-inject-head
- A string to put at the beginning of each new message, followed by a
newline. [Obsolete] The escape sequences tabulator
‘
\t
’ and newline ‘\n
’ are understood (use thewysh
prefix whenset
ting the variable(s) instead). - message-inject-tail
- A string to put at the end of each new message, followed by a newline.
[Obsolete] The escape sequences tabulator
‘
\t
’ and newline ‘\n
’ are understood (use thewysh
prefix whenset
ting the variable(s) instead). Also see on-compose-leave. - metoo
- (Boolean) Usually, when an
alias
expansion contains the sender, the sender is removed from the expansion. Setting this option suppresses these removals. Note that a set metoo also causes a ‘-m
’ option to be passed through to the mta (Mail-Transfer-Agent); though most of the modern MTAs no longer document this flag, no MTA is known which does not support it (for historical compatibility). - mime-allow-text-controls
- (Boolean) When sending messages, each part of the message is
MIME-inspected in order to classify the
‘
Content-Type:
’ and ‘Content-Transfer-Encoding:
’ (see mime-encoding) that is required to send this part over mail transport, i.e., a computation rather similar to what the file(1) command produces when used with the ‘--mime
’ option.This classification however treats text files which are encoded in UTF-16 (seen for HTML files) and similar character sets as binary octet-streams, forcefully changing any ‘
text/plain
’ or ‘text/html
’ specification to ‘application/octet-stream
’: If that actually happens a yet unset charset MIME parameter is set to ‘binary
’, effectively making it impossible for the receiving MUA to automatically interpret the contents of the part.If this variable is set, and the data was unambiguously identified as text data at first glance (by a ‘
.txt
’ or ‘.html
’ file extension), then the original ‘Content-Type:
’ will not be overwritten. - mime-alternative-favour-rich
- (Boolean) If this variable is set then rich MIME alternative parts (e.g., HTML) will be preferred in favour of included plain text versions when displaying messages, provided that a handler exists which produces output that can be (re)integrated into Mail's normal visual display.
- mime-counter-evidence
- Normally the ‘
Content-Type:
’ field is used to decide how to handle MIME parts. Some MUAs, however, do not use The mime.types files (also see HTML mail and MIME attachments) or a similar mechanism to correctly classify content, but specify an unspecific MIME type (‘application/octet-stream
’) even for plain text attachments. If this variable is set then Mail will try to re-classify such MIME message parts, if possible, for example via a possibly existing attachment filename. A non-empty value may also be given, in which case a number is expected, actually a carrier of bits, best specified as a binary value, like ‘0b1111
’.- If bit two is set (counting from 1, decimal 2) then the detected
mimetype
will be carried along with the message and be used for deciding which MIME handler is to be used, for example; when displaying such a MIME part the part-info will indicate the overridden content-type by showing a plus sign ‘+
’. - If bit three is set (decimal 4) then the counter-evidence is always produced and a positive result will be used as the MIME type, even forcefully overriding the parts given MIME type.
- If bit four is set (decimal 8) as a last resort the actual content of
‘
application/octet-stream
’ parts will be inspected, so that data which looks like plain text can be treated as such. This mode is even more relaxed when data is to be displayed to the user or used as a message quote (data consumers which mangle data for display purposes, which includes masking of control characters, for example).
- If bit two is set (counting from 1, decimal 2) then the detected
- mime-encoding
- The MIME ‘
Content-Transfer-Encoding
’ to use in outgoing text messages and message parts, where applicable (7-bit clean text messages are without an encoding if possible):- ‘
8bit
’ - (Or ‘
8b
’.) 8-bit transport effectively causes the raw data be passed through unchanged, but may cause problems when transferring mail messages over channels that are not ESMTP (RFC 1869) compliant. Also, several input data constructs are not allowed by the specifications and may cause a different transfer-encoding to be used. By established rules and popular demand occurrences of ‘^From_
’ (see mbox-rfc4155) will be MBOXO quoted (prefixed with greater-than sign ‘>
’) instead of causing a non-destructive encoding like ‘quoted-printable
’ to be chosen, unless context (like message signing) requires otherwise. - ‘
quoted-printable
’ - (Or ‘
qp
’.) Quoted-printable encoding is 7-bit clean and has the property that ASCII characters are passed through unchanged, so that an english message can be read as-is; it is also acceptable for other single-byte locales that share many characters with ASCII, for example ISO-8859-1. The encoding will cause a large overhead for messages in other character sets: for example it will require up to twelve (12) bytes to encode a single UTF-8 character of four (4) bytes. It is the default encoding. - ‘
base64
’ - (Or ‘
b64
’.) This encoding is 7-bit clean and will always be used for binary data. This encoding has a constant input:output ratio of 3:4, regardless of the character set of the input data it will encode three bytes of input to four bytes of output. This transfer-encoding is not human readable without performing a decoding step.
- ‘
- mime-force-sendout
- (Boolean)[Option] Whenever it is not acceptable to fail sending out
messages because of non-convertible character content this variable may be
set. It will, as a last resort, classify the part content as
‘
application/octet-stream
’. Please refer to the section Character sets for the complete picture of character set conversion, and HTML mail and MIME attachments for how to internally or externally handle part content. - mimetypes-load-control
- Can be used to control which of
The mime.types files are
loaded: if the letter ‘
u
’ is part of the option value, then the user's personal ~/.mime.types file will be loaded (if it exists); likewise the letter ‘s
’ controls loading of the system wide /etc/mime.types; directives found in the user file take precedence, letter matching is case-insensitive. If this variable is not set Mail will try to load both files. Incorporation of the Mail-built-in MIME types cannot be suppressed, but they will be matched last (the order can be listed viamimetype
).More sources can be specified by using a different syntax: if the value string contains an equals sign ‘
=
’ then it is instead parsed as a comma-separated list of the described letters plus ‘f=FILENAME
’ pairs; the given filenames will be expanded and loaded, and their content may use the extended syntax that is described in the section The mime.types files. Directives found in such files always take precedence (are prepended to the MIME type cache). - mta
- Select an alternate Mail-Transfer-Agent by either specifying the full
pathname of an executable (a
‘
file://
’ prefix may be given), or [Option]ally a SMTP aka SUBMISSION protocol URL [v15-compat]:submissions://[user[:password]@]server[:port]
([no v15-compat]: ‘
[smtp://]server[:port]
’.) The default has been chosen at compile time. MTA data transfers are always performed in asynchronous child processes, and without supervision unless either the sendwait or the verbose variable is set. Also see mta-bcc-ok. [Option]ally expansion of aliases(5) can be performed by setting mta-aliases.For testing purposes there is the ‘
test
’ pseudo-MTA, which dumps to standard output or optionally to a file, and honours mbox-fcc-and-pcc:$ echo text | mail -:/ -Smta=test -s ubject ex@am.ple $ </dev/null mail -:/ -Smta=test://./xy ex@am.ple
For a file-based MTA it may be necessary to set mta-argv0 in in order to choose the right target of a modern mailwrapper(8) environment. It will be passed command line arguments from several possible sources: from the variable mta-arguments if set, from the command line if given and the variable expandargv allows their use. Argument processing of the MTA will be terminated with a
--
separator.The otherwise occurring implicit usage of the following MTA command line arguments can be disabled by setting the boolean variable mta-no-default-arguments (which will also disable passing
--
to the MTA):-i
(for not treating a line with only a dot ‘.
’ character as the end of input),-m
(shall the variable metoo be set) and-v
(if the verbose variable is set); in conjunction with the-r
command line option or r-option-implicit-f
as well as possibly-F
will (not) be passed.[Option]ally Mail can send mail over SMTP aka SUBMISSION network connections to a single defined smart host by setting this variable to a SMTP or SUBMISSION URL (see On URL syntax and credential lookup). An authentication scheme can be specified via the variable chain smtp-auth. Encrypted network connections are [Option]ally available, the section Encrypted network communication should give an overview and provide links to more information on this. Note that with some mail providers it may be necessary to set the smtp-hostname variable in order to use a specific combination of from, hostname and mta. Network communication socket timeouts are configurable via socket-connect-timeout. All generated network traffic may be proxied over a SOCKS socks-proxy, it can be logged by setting verbose twice. The following SMTP variants may be used:
- The plain SMTP protocol (RFC 5321) that normally lives on the server
port 25 and requires setting the
smtp-use-starttls variable to enter a TLS
encrypted session state. Assign a value like [v15-compat]
‘
smtp://[user[:password]@]server[:port]
’ ([no v15-compat] ‘smtp://server[:port]
’) to choose this protocol. - The so-called SMTPS which is supposed to live on server port 465 and
is automatically TLS secured. Unfortunately it never became a
standardized protocol and may thus not be supported by your hosts
network service database – in fact the port number has already
been reassigned to other protocols!
SMTPS is nonetheless a commonly offered protocol and thus can be chosen by assigning a value like [v15-compat] ‘
smtps://[user[:password]@]server[:port]
’ ([no v15-compat] ‘smtps://server[:port]
’); due to the mentioned problems it is usually necessary to explicitly specify the port as ‘:465
’, however. - The SUBMISSION protocol (RFC 6409) lives on server port 587 and is
identically to the SMTP protocol from Mail's point of view; it
requires setting smtp-use-starttls to enter a
TLS secured session state; e.g., [v15-compat]
‘
submission://[user[:password]@]server[:port]
’. - The SUBMISSIONS protocol (RFC 8314) that lives on server port 465 and
is TLS secured by default. It can be chosen by assigning a value like
[v15-compat]
‘
submissions://[user[:password]@]server[:port]
’. Due to the problems mentioned for SMTPS above and the fact that SUBMISSIONS is new and a successor that lives on the same port as the historical engineering mismanagement named SMTPS, it is usually necessary to explicitly specify the port as ‘:465
’.
- The plain SMTP protocol (RFC 5321) that normally lives on the server
port 25 and requires setting the
smtp-use-starttls variable to enter a TLS
encrypted session state. Assign a value like [v15-compat]
‘
- mta-aliases
- [Option] If set to a path pointing to a text file in valid MTA (Postfix)
aliases(5) format, the file is
loaded and cached (manageable with
mtaaliases
), and henceforth plain ‘name
’ (see expandaddr) message receiver names are recursively expanded as a last expansion step, after the distribution lists which can be created withalias
. Constraints on aliases(5) content support: only local addresses (names) which are valid usernames (‘[a-z_][a-z0-9_-]*[$]?
’) are treated as expandable aliases, and [v15 behaviour may differ] ‘:include:/file/name
’ directives are not supported. By including ‘-name
’ in expandaddr it can be asserted that only expanded names (mail addresses) are passed through to the MTA. - mta-arguments
- Arguments to pass through to a file-based mta
(Mail-Transfer-Agent), parsed according to
Shell-style argument
quoting into an array of arguments which will be joined onto MTA
options from other sources, for example ‘
? wysh set mta-arguments='-t -X "/tmp/my log"'
’. - mta-no-default-arguments
- (Boolean) Avoids passing standard command line options to a file-based mta (please see there).
- mta-no-receiver-arguments
- (Boolean) By default all receiver addresses will be passed as command line
options to a file-based mta. Setting this variable
disables this behaviour to aid those MTAs which employ special treatment
of such arguments. Doing so can make it necessary to pass a
-t
via mta-arguments, to testify the MTA that it should use the passed message as a template. - mta-argv0
- Many systems use a so-called mailwrapper(8) environment to ensure compatibility with sendmail(1). This works by inspecting the name that was used to invoke the mail delivery system. If this variable is set then the mailwrapper (the program that is actually executed when calling the file-based mta) will treat its contents as that name.
- mta-bcc-ok
- (Boolean) In violation of RFC 5322 some MTAs do not remove
‘
Bcc:
’ header lines from transported messages after having noted the respective receivers for addressing purposes. (The MTAs Exim and Courier for example require the command line option-t
to enforce removal.) Unless this is set corresponding receivers are addressed by protocol-specific means or MTA command line options only, the header itself is stripped before being sent over the wire. - netrc-lookup-USER@HOST, netrc-lookup-HOST, netrc-lookup
- (Boolean)[v15-compat][Option] Used to control usage of the user's
~/.netrc file for lookup of account credentials,
as documented in the section
On URL syntax
and credential lookup and for the command
netrc
; the section The .netrc file documents the file format. Also see netrc-pipe. - netrc-pipe
- [v15-compat][Option] When ~/.netrc is loaded (see
netrc
and netrc-lookup) then Mail will read the output of a shell pipe instead of the user's ~/.netrc file if this variable is set (to the desired shell command). This can be used to, for example, store ~/.netrc in encrypted form: ‘? set netrc-pipe='gpg -qd ~/.netrc.pgp'
’. - newfolders
- [Option] If this variable has the value
‘
maildir
’, newly created local folders will be in Maildir instead of MBOX format. - newmail
- Checks for new mail in the current folder each time the prompt is shown. A
Maildir folder must be re-scanned to determine if new mail has arrived. If
this variable is set to the special value
‘
nopoll
’ then a Maildir folder will not be rescanned completely, but only timestamp changes are detected. Maildir folders are [Option]al. - outfolder
- (Boolean) Causes a non-absolute filename specified in
record, as well as the sender-based filenames of the
Copy
,Save
,Followup
andfollowup
commands to be interpreted relative to the folder directory rather than relative to the current directory. - on-account-cleanup-ACCOUNT, on-account-cleanup
- Macro hook which will be called once an
account
is left, as the very last step before unrolling per-accountlocalopts
. This hook is run even in case of fatal errors, including those generated by switching to the account as such, and it is advisable to perform only absolutely necessary actions, like cleaning upalternates
, for example. The specialized form is used in favour of the generic one if found. - on-compose-cleanup
- Macro hook which will be called after the message has been sent (or not,
in case of failures), as the very last step before unrolling compose mode
localopts
. This hook is run even in case of fatal errors, and it is advisable to perform only absolutely necessary actions, like cleaning upalternates
, for example.For compose mode hooks that may affect the message content please see on-compose-enter, on-compose-leave, on-compose-splice. [v15 behaviour may differ] This hook exists because
alias
,alternates
,commandalias
,shortcut
, to name a few, are neither covered bylocalopts
nor bylocal
: changes applied in compose mode will continue to be in effect thereafter. - on-compose-enter, on-compose-leave
- Macro hooks which will be called once compose mode is entered, and after
composing has been finished, respectively; the exact order of the steps
taken is documented for
~.
, one of the COMMAND ESCAPES. Context about the message being worked on can be queried viadigmsg
.localopts
are enabled for these hooks, and changes on variables will be forgotten after the message has been sent. on-compose-cleanup can be used to perform other necessary cleanup steps.Here is an example that injects a signature via message-inject-tail; instead using on-compose-splice to simply inject the file of desire via
~<
or~<!
may be a better approach.define t_ocl { vput ! i cat ~/.mysig if $? -eq 0 vput csop message-inject-tail trim-end $i end # Alternatively readctl create ~/.mysig if $? -eq 0 readall i if $? -eq 0 vput csop message-inject-tail trim-end $i end readctl remove ~/.mysig end } set on-compose-leave=t_ocl
- on-compose-splice, on-compose-splice-shell
- These hooks run once the normal compose mode is finished, but before the
on-compose-leave macro hook is called etc. Both
hooks will be executed in a subprocess, with their input and output
connected to Mail such that they can act as if they would be an
interactive user. The difference in between them is that the latter is a
SHELL
command, whereas the former is a normaldefine
d macro, but which is restricted to a small set of commands (the verbose output of for examplelist
will indicate said capability).localopts
are enabled for these hooks (in the parent process), causing any setting to be forgotten after the message has been sent; on-compose-cleanup can be used to perform other cleanup as necessary.During execution of these hooks Mail will temporarily forget whether it has been started in interactive mode, (a restricted set of) COMMAND ESCAPES will always be available, and for guaranteed reproducibilities sake escape and ifs will be set to their defaults. The compose mode command
~^
has been especially designed for scriptability (via these hooks). The first line the hook will read on its standard input is the protocol version of said command escape, currently “0 0 2”: backward incompatible protocol changes have to be expected.Care must be taken to avoid deadlocks and other false control flow: if both involved processes wait for more input to happen at the same time, or one does not expect more input but the other is stuck waiting for consumption of its output, etc. There is no automatic synchronization of the hook: it will not be stopped automatically just because it, e.g., emits ‘
~x
’. The hooks will however receive a termination signal if the parent enters an error condition. [v15 behaviour may differ] Protection against and interaction with signals is not yet given; it is likely that in the future these scripts will be placed in an isolated session, which is signalled in its entirety as necessary.define ocs_signature { read version echo '~< ~/.mysig' # '~<! fortune pathtofortunefile' } set on-compose-splice=ocs_signature wysh set on-compose-splice-shell=$'\ read version;\ printf "hello $version! Headers: ";\ echo \'~^header list\';\ read status result;\ echo "status=$status result=$result";\ ' define ocsm { read version echo Splice protocol version is $version echo '~^h l'; read hl; vput csop es subs "${hl}" 0 1 if "$es" != 2 echoerr 'Cannot read header list'; echo '~x'; xit endif if "$hl" !%?case ' cc' echo '~^h i cc "Diet is your <mirr.or>"'; read es;\ vput csop es substring "${es}" 0 1 if "$es" != 2 echoerr 'Cannot insert Cc: header'; echo '~x' # (no xit, macro finishes anyway) endif endif } set on-compose-splice=ocsm
- on-history-addition
- This hook will be called if an entry is about to be added to the
history
of the MLE, as documented in On terminal control and line editor. It will be called with three arguments: the first is the name of the input context (seebind
), the second is either an empty string or the matching history-gabby type, and the third being the complete command line to be added. The entry will not be added to history if the hook uses a non-0return
. [v15 behaviour may differ] A future version will give the expanded command name as the third argument, followed by the tokenized command line as parsed in the remaining arguments, the first of which is the original unexpanded command name; i.e., one may do ‘
’ and will then be able to access the positional parameters as usual via *, #, 1 etc.shift
4 - on-main-loop-tick
- This hook will be called whenever the program's main event loop is about
to read the next input line. Note variable and other changes it performs
are not scoped as via
localopts
! - on-program-exit
- This hook will be called when the program exits, whether via
exit
orquit
, or because the send mode is done. Note: this runs late and so terminal settings etc. are already teared down. - on-resend-cleanup
- [v15 behaviour may differ] Identical to
on-compose-cleanup, but is only triggered by
resend
. - on-resend-enter
- [v15 behaviour may differ] Identical to
on-compose-enter, but is only triggered by
resend
; currently there is nodigmsg
support, for example. - page
- (Boolean) If set, each message feed through the command given for
pipe
is followed by a formfeed character ‘\f
’. - password-USER@HOST, password-HOST, password
- [v15-compat] Variable chain that sets a password, which is used in case none has been given in the protocol and account-specific URL; as a last resort Mail will ask for a password on the user's terminal if the authentication method requires a password. Specifying passwords in a startup file is generally a security risk; the file should be readable by the invoking user only.
- password-USER@HOST
- [no v15-compat] (see the chain above for [v15-compat]) Set the password
for ‘
USER
’ when connecting to ‘HOST
’. If no such variable is defined for a host, the user will be asked for a password on standard input. Specifying passwords in a startup file is generally a security risk; the file should be readable by the invoking user only. - piperaw
- (Boolean) Send messages to the
pipe
command without performing MIME and character set conversions. - pipe-EXTENSION
- Identical to pipe-TYPE/SUBTYPE except that
‘
EXTENSION
’ (normalized to lowercase using character mappings of the ASCII charset) denotes a file extension, for example ‘xhtml
’. Handlers registered using this method take precedence. - pipe-TYPE/SUBTYPE
- A MIME message part identified as
‘
TYPE/SUBTYPE
’ (case-insensitive, normalized to lowercase using character mappings of the ASCII charset) is displayed or quoted, its text is filtered through the value of this variable interpreted as a shell command. Unless noted only parts displayable as inline plain text (seecopiousoutput
) are covered, other MIME parts will only be considered by and formimeview
.The special value question mark ‘
?
’ forces interpretation of the message part as plain text, for example ‘set pipe-application/xml=?
’. (This can also be achieved by adding a MIME type-marker viamimetype
.) [Option]ally MIME type handlers may be defined via The Mailcap files to which should be referred to for documentation of flags likecopiousoutput
. Question mark is indeed a trigger character to indicate flags that adjust behaviour and usage of the rest of the value, the shell command, for example:? set pipe-X/Y='?!++=? vim ${MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY}'
- ‘
*
’ - The command output can be reintegrated into this MUA's normal
processing:
copiousoutput
. Implied when using a plain ‘’.
- ‘
#
’ - Only use this handler for display, not for quoting a message:
x-mailx-noquote
. - ‘
&
’ - Run the command asynchronously, do not wait for the handler to exit:
x-mailx-async
. The standard output of the command will go to /dev/null. - ‘
!
’ - The command must be run on an interactive terminal, the terminal will
temporarily be released for it to run:
needsterminal
. - ‘
+
’ - Request creation of a zero-sized temporary file, the absolute pathname
of which will be made accessible via the environment variable
MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY
:x-mailx-tmpfile
. If given twice then the file will be unlinked automatically by Mail when the command loop is entered again at latest:x-mailx-tmpfile-unlink
; it is an error to use automatic deletion in conjunction withx-mailx-async
. - ‘
=
’ - Normally the MIME part content is passed to the handler via standard
input; with this the data will instead be written into
MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY
(x-mailx-tmpfile-fill
), the creation of which is implied; in order to cause automatic deletion of the temporary file two plus signs ‘++
’ still have to be used. - ‘
t
’ - Text type-marker: display this as normal plain text (for type-markers:
The mime.types files).
Identical to only giving plain
‘
?
’, impliescopiousoutput
. - ‘
h
’ - [Option] HTML type-marker: display via built-in HTML-to-text filter.
Implies
copiousoutput
. - ‘
?
’ - To avoid ambiguities with normal shell command content another question mark can be used to forcefully terminate interpretation of remaining characters. (Any character not in this list will have the same effect.)
Some information about the MIME part to be displayed is embedded into the environment of the shell command:
MAILX_CONTENT
- The MIME content-type of the part, if known, the empty string otherwise.
MAILX_CONTENT_EVIDENCE
- If mime-counter-evidence includes the
carry-around-bit (2), then this will be set to the detected MIME
content-type; not only then identical to
MAILX_CONTENT
otherwise. MAILX_EXTERNAL_BODY_URL
- MIME parts of type ‘
message/external-body access-type=url
’ will store the access URL in this variable, it is empty otherwise. URL targets should not be activated automatically, without supervision. MAILX_FILENAME
- The filename, if any is set, the empty string otherwise.
MAILX_FILENAME_GENERATED
- A random string.
MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY
- If temporary file creation has been requested through the command prefix this variable will be set and contain the absolute pathname of the temporary file.
- ‘
- pop3-auth-USER@HOST, pop3-auth-HOST, pop3-auth
- [Option][v15-compat] Variable chain that sets the POP3 authentication
method. Supported are the default
‘
plain
’, [v15-compat] ‘oauthbearer
’ (see FAQ entry But, how about XOAUTH2 / OAUTHBEARER?), as well as [v15-compat] ‘external
’ and ‘externanon
’ for TLS secured connections which pass a client certificate via tls-config-pairs. There may be the [Option]al method [v15-compat] ‘gssapi
’. ‘externanon
’ does not need any user credentials, ‘external
’ and ‘gssapi
’ need a user, the remains also require a password. ‘externanon
’ solely builds upon the credentials passed via a client certificate, and is usually the way to go since tested servers do not actually follow RFC 4422, and fail if additional credentials are actually passed. Unless pop3-no-apop is set the ‘plain
’ method will [Option]ally be replaced with APOP if possible (see there). - pop3-bulk-load-USER@HOST, pop3-bulk-load-HOST, pop3-bulk-load
- (Boolean)[Option] When accessing a POP3 server Mail loads the headers of the messages, and only requests the message bodies on user request. For the POP3 protocol this means that the message headers will be downloaded twice. If this variable is set then Mail will download only complete messages from the given POP3 server(s) instead.
- pop3-keepalive-USER@HOST, pop3-keepalive-HOST, pop3-keepalive
- [Option] POP3 servers close the connection after a period of inactivity;
the standard requires this to be at least 10 minutes, but practical
experience may vary. Setting this variable to a numeric value greater than
‘
0
’ causes a ‘NOOP
’ command to be sent each value seconds if no other operation is performed. - pop3-no-apop-USER@HOST, pop3-no-apop-HOST, pop3-no-apop
- (Boolean)[Option] Unless this variable is set the MD5 based
‘
APOP
’ authentication method will be used instead of a chosen ‘plain
’ pop3-auth when connecting to a POP3 server that advertises support. The advantage of ‘APOP
’ is that only a single packet is sent for the user/password tuple. (Originally also that the password is not sent in clear text over the wire, but for one MD5 does not any longer offer sufficient security, and then today transport is almost ever TLS secured.) Note that pop3-no-apop-HOST requires [v15-compat]. - pop3-use-starttls-USER@HOST, pop3-use-starttls-HOST, pop3-use-starttls
- (Boolean)[Option] Causes Mail to issue a
‘
STLS
’ command to make an unencrypted POP3 session TLS encrypted. This functionality is not supported by all servers, and is not used if the session is already encrypted by the POP3S method. Note that pop3-use-starttls-HOST requires [v15-compat]. - posix
- (Boolean) This flag enables POSIX mode, which changes behaviour of Mail
where that deviates from standardized behaviour. It is automatically
squared with the environment variable
POSIXLY_CORRECT
, changing the one will adjust the other. The following behaviour is covered and enforced by this mechanism:- In non-interactive mode, any error encountered while loading resource
files during program startup will cause a program exit, whereas in
interactive mode such errors will stop loading of the currently loaded
(stack of) file(s, i.e., recursively). These exits can be circumvented
on a per-command base by using
ignerr
, one of the Command modifiers, for each command which shall be allowed to fail. alternates
will replace the list of alternate addresses instead of appending to it. In addition alternates will only be honoured for any sort of messagereply
, and for aliases.- The variable inserting COMMAND
ESCAPES
~A
,~a
,~I
and~i
will expand embedded character sequences ‘\t
’ horizontal tabulator and ‘\n
’ line feed. [v15 behaviour may differ] For compatibility reasons this step will always be performed. - Reading in messages via
~f
(COMMAND ESCAPES) will use the ‘type
’ not the ‘forward
’headerpick
selection. - Upon changing the active
folder
no summary ofheaders
will be displayed even if header is set. - Setting ignoreeof implies the behaviour described by dot.
- The variable keep is extended to cover any empty mailbox, not only empty primary system mailboxes: they will be removed when they are left in empty state otherwise.
- Each command has an exit ? and error ! status that overwrites that of the last command. In POSIX mode the program exit status will signal failure regardless unless all messages were successfully sent out to the mta; also see sendwait.
- In non-interactive mode, any error encountered while loading resource
files during program startup will cause a program exit, whereas in
interactive mode such errors will stop loading of the currently loaded
(stack of) file(s, i.e., recursively). These exits can be circumvented
on a per-command base by using
- print-alternatives
- (Boolean) When a MIME message part of type
‘
multipart/alternative
’ is displayed and it contains a subpart of type ‘text/plain
’, other parts are normally discarded. Setting this variable causes all subparts to be displayed, just as if the surrounding part was of type ‘multipart/mixed
’. - prompt
- The string used as a prompt in interactive mode. Whenever the variable is
evaluated the value is treated as if specified within dollar-single-quotes
(see Shell-style
argument quoting). This (post-assignment, i.e., second) expansion can
be used to embed status information, for example ?,
!, account or
mailbox-display.
In order to embed characters which should not be counted when calculating the visual width of the resulting string, enclose the characters of interest in a pair of reverse solidus escaped brackets: ‘
\[\E[0m\]
’; a slot for coloured prompts is also available with the [Option]al commandcolour
. Prompting may be prevented by setting this to the null string (aka ‘set noprompt
’). - prompt2
- This string is used for secondary prompts, but is otherwise identical to
prompt. The default is
‘
..
’. - quiet
- (Boolean) Suppresses the printing of the version when first invoked.
- quote
- If set messages processed by variants of
followup
andreply
will start with the original message, lines of which prefixed by indentprefix, taking into account quote-chars and quote-fold. No headers will be quoted when set without value or for ‘noheading
’, for ‘headers
’ the ‘type
’headerpick
selection will be included in the quote, ‘allbodies
’ embeds the (body) contents of all MIME parts, and ‘allheaders
’ also includes all headers. The quoted message will be enclosed by the expansions of quote-inject-head and quote-inject-tail. Also see quote-add-cc, quote-as-attachment and~Q
, one of the COMMAND ESCAPES. - quote-add-cc
- (Boolean) Whether senders of messages quoted via
~Q
shall be made members of the carbon copies ‘Cc:
’ list. - quote-as-attachment
- (Boolean) Add the original message in its entirety as a
‘
message/rfc822
’ MIME attachment when replying to a message. Note this works regardless of the setting of quote. - quote-chars
- Can be set to a string consisting of non-whitespace ASCII characters which
shall be treated as quotation leaders, the default being
‘
>|}:
’. - quote-fold
- [Option] Can be set in addition to indentprefix, and creates a more fancy quotation in that leading quotation characters (quote-chars) are compressed and overlong lines are folded. quote-fold can be set to either one, two or three (space separated) numeric values, which are interpreted as the maximum (goal) and the minimum line length, respectively, in a spirit rather equal to the fmt(1) program, but line- instead of paragraph-based. The third value is used as the maximum line length instead of the first if no better break point can be found; it is ignored unless it is larger than the minimum and smaller than the maximum. If not set explicitly the minimum will reflect the goal algorithmically. The goal cannot be smaller than the length of indentprefix plus some additional pad; necessary adjustments take place silently.
- quote-inject-head, quote-inject-tail
- The strings to put before and after the text of a
quoted message, if non-empty, and respectively. The
former defaults to ‘
%f wrote:\n\n
’. Special format directives will be expanded if possible, and if so configured the output will be folded according to quote-fold. Format specifiers in the given strings start with a percent sign ‘%
’ and expand values of the original message, unless noted otherwise. Note that names and addresses are not subject to the setting of showto. Valid format specifiers are:- ‘
%%
’ - A plain percent sign.
- ‘
%a
’ - The address(es) of the sender(s).
- ‘
%d
’ - The date found in the ‘
Date:
’ header of the message when datefield is set (the default), otherwise the date when the message was received. Formatting can be controlled by assigning a strftime(3) format string to datefield (and datefield-markout-older). - ‘
%f
’ - The full name(s) (name and address, as given) of the sender(s).
- ‘
%i
’ - The ‘
Message-ID:
’. - ‘
%n
’ - The real name(s) of the sender(s) if there is one and showname allows usage, the address(es) otherwise.
- ‘
%r
’ - The senders real name(s) if there is one, the address(es) otherwise.
- ‘
- r-option-implicit
- (Boolean) Setting this option evaluates the contents of
from (or, if that contains multiple addresses,
sender) and passes the results onto the used
(file-based) MTA as described for the
-r
option (empty argument case). - recipients-in-cc
- (Boolean) When doing a
reply
, the original ‘From:
’ and ‘To:
’ as well as addressees which possibly came in via ‘Reply-To:
’ and ‘Mail-Followup-To:
’ are by default merged into the new ‘To:
’. If this variable is set a sensitive algorithm tries to place in ‘To:
’ only the sender of the message being replied to, others are placed in ‘Cc:
’. - record
- Unless this variable is defined, no copies of outgoing mail will be saved.
If defined it gives the pathname, subject to the usual
Filename
transformations, of a folder where all new, replied-to or forwarded
messages are saved: when saving to this folder fails the message is not
sent, but instead saved to
DEAD
. The standard defines that relative (fully expanded) paths are to be interpreted relative to the current directory (cwd
), to force interpretation relative to folder outfolder needs to be set in addition. - record-files
- (Boolean) If this variable is set the meaning of record will be extended to cover messages which target only file and pipe recipients (see expandaddr). These address types will not appear in recipient lists unless add-file-recipients is also set.
- record-resent
- (Boolean) If this variable is set the meaning of
record will be extended to also cover the
resend
andResend
commands. - (Boolean) If this variable is set Mail first tries to use the same character set of the original message for replies. If this fails, the mechanism described in Character sets is evaluated as usual.
- Can be set to a comma-separated list of (case-insensitive according to
ASCII rules) strings which shall be recognized in addition to the built-in
strings as ‘
Subject:
’ reply message indicators – built-in are ‘Re:
’, which is mandated by RFC 5322, as well as the german ‘Aw:
’, ‘Antw:
’, and the ‘Wg:
’ which often has been seen in the wild; I.e., the separating colon has to be specified explicitly. - A list of addresses to put into the
‘
Reply-To:
’ field of the message header. Members of this list are handled as if they were in thealternates
list. - replyto
- [Obsolete] Variant of reply-to.
- Controls whether a ‘
Reply-To:
’ header is honoured when replying to a message viareply
orLreply
. This is a quadoption; if set without a value it defaults to “yes”. - Standards like DKIM and (in conjunction with) DMARC caused many
Mailing lists to use sender
address rewriting in the style of ‘
Name via List <list@address>
’, where the original sender address often being placed in ‘Reply-To:
’. If this is set and a ‘Reply-To:
’ exists, and consists of only one addressee (!), then that is used in place of the pretended sender. This works independently from reply-to-honour. The optional value, a comma-separated list of strings, offers more fine-grained control on when swapping shall be used; for now supported is mlist, here swapping occurs if the sender is a mailing-list as defined bymlist
. - rfc822-body-from_
- (Boolean) This variable can be used to force displaying a so-called
‘
From_
’ line for messages that are embedded into an envelope mail via the ‘message/rfc822
’ MIME mechanism, for more visual convenience, also see mbox-rfc4155. - save
- (Boolean) Enable saving of (partial) messages in
DEAD
upon interrupt or delivery error. - screen
- The number of lines that represents a “screenful” of lines,
used in
headers
summary display,from
search
ing, messagetop
line display and scrolling viaz
. If this variable is not set Mail falls back to a calculation based upon the detected terminal window size and the baud rate: the faster the terminal, the more will be shown. Overall screen dimensions and pager usage is influenced by the environment variablesCOLUMNS
andLINES
and the variable crt. - searchheaders
- (Boolean) Expand message list specifiers in the form
‘
/x:y
’ to all messages containing the substring “y” in the header field ‘x
’. The string search is case insensitive. - sendcharsets
- [Option] A comma-separated list of character set names that can be used in outgoing internet mail. The value of the variable charset-8bit is automatically appended to this list of character sets. If no character set conversion capabilities are compiled into Mail then the only supported charset is ttycharset. Also see sendcharsets-else-ttycharset and refer to the section Character sets for the complete picture of character set conversion in Mail.
- sendcharsets-else-ttycharset
- (Boolean)[Option] If this variable is set, but
sendcharsets is not, then Mail acts as if
sendcharsets had been set to the value of the
variable ttycharset. In effect this combination
passes through the message data in the character set of the current locale
encoding: therefore mail message text will be (assumed to be) in
ISO-8859-1 encoding when send from within a ISO-8859-1 locale, and in
UTF-8 encoding when send from within an UTF-8 locale.
The 8-bit fallback charset-8bit never comes into play as ttycharset is implicitly assumed to be 8-bit and capable to represent all files the user may specify (as is the case when no character set conversion support is available in Mail and the only supported character set is ttycharset, see Character sets). This might be a problem for scripts which use the suggested ‘
LC_ALL=C
’ setting, since in this case the character set is US-ASCII by definition, so that it is better to also override ttycharset, then; and/or do something like the following in the resource file:# Avoid ASCII "propagates to 8-bit" when scripting \if ! t && "$LC_ALL" != C && "$LC_CTYPE" != C \set sendcharsets-else-ttycharset \end
- sender
- An address that is put into the
‘
Sender:
’ field of outgoing messages, quoting RFC 5322: the mailbox of the agent responsible for the actual transmission of the message. This field should normally not be used unless the from field contains more than one address, on which case it is required. [v15 behaviour may differ] Please expect automatic management of the from and sender relationship. Dependent on the context this address is handled as if it were in the list ofalternates
. Also see-r
, r-option-implicit. - sendmail
- [Obsolete] Predecessor of mta.
- sendmail-arguments
- [Obsolete] Predecessor of mta-arguments.
- sendmail-no-default-arguments
- [Obsolete](Boolean) Predecessor of mta-no-default-arguments.
- sendmail-progname
- [Obsolete] Predecessor of mta-argv0.
- sendwait
- Sending messages to the chosen mta or to
command-pipe receivers (see
On sending
mail, and non-interactive mode) will be performed asynchronously. This
means that only startup errors of the respective program will be
recognizable, but no delivery errors. Also, no guarantees can be made as
to when the respective program will actually run, as well as to when they
will have produced output.
If this variable is set then child program exit is waited for, and its exit status code is used to decide about success. Remarks: in conflict with the POSIX standard this variable is built-in to be initially set. Another difference is that it can have a value, which is interpreted as a comma-separated list of case-insensitive strings naming specific subsystems for which synchronousness shall be ensured (only). Possible values are ‘
mta
’ for mta delivery, and ‘pcc
’ for command-pipe receivers. - showlast
- (Boolean) This setting causes Mail to start at the last message instead of
the first one when opening a mail folder, as well as with
from
andheaders
. - showname
- (Boolean) Causes Mail to use the sender's real name instead of the plain address in the header field summary and in message specifications.
- showto
- (Boolean) Causes the recipient of the message to be shown in the header summary if the message was sent by the user.
- Sign
- The value backing
~A
, one of the COMMAND ESCAPES. Also see message-inject-tail, on-compose-leave and on-compose-splice. - sign
- The value backing
~a
, one of the COMMAND ESCAPES. Also see message-inject-tail, on-compose-leave and on-compose-splice. - signature
- [Obsolete] Please use on-compose-splice or on-compose-splice-shell or on-compose-leave and (if necessary) message-inject-tail instead!
- skipemptybody
- (Boolean) If an outgoing message has an empty first or only message part,
do not send, but discard it, successfully (also see the command line
option
-E
). - smime-ca-dir, smime-ca-file
- [Option] Specify the location of trusted CA certificates in PEM (Privacy Enhanced Mail) for the purpose of verification of S/MIME signed messages. tls-ca-dir documents the necessary preparation steps to use the former. The set of CA certificates which are built into the TLS library can be explicitly turned off by setting smime-ca-no-defaults, and further fine-tuning is possible via smime-ca-flags.
- smime-ca-flags
- [Option] Can be used to fine-tune behaviour of the X509 CA certificate storage, and the certificate verification that is used. The actual values and their meanings are documented for tls-ca-flags.
- smime-ca-no-defaults
- (Boolean)[Option] Do not load the default CA locations that are built into the used to TLS library to verify S/MIME signed messages.
- smime-cipher-USER@HOST, smime-cipher
- [Option] Specifies the cipher to use when generating S/MIME encrypted
messages (for the specified account). RFC 5751 mandates a default of
‘
aes128
’ (AES-128 CBC). Possible values are (case-insensitive and) in decreasing cipher strength: ‘aes256
’ (AES-256 CBC), ‘aes192
’ (AES-192 CBC), ‘aes128
’ (AES-128 CBC), ‘des3
’ (DES EDE3 CBC, 168 bits; default if ‘aes128
’ is not available) and ‘des
’ (DES CBC, 56 bits).The actually available cipher algorithms depend on the cryptographic library that Mail uses. [Option] Support for more cipher algorithms may be available through dynamic loading via EVP_get_cipherbyname(3) (OpenSSL) if Mail has been compiled to support this.
- smime-crl-dir
- [Option] Specifies a directory that contains files with CRLs in PEM format to use when verifying S/MIME messages.
- smime-crl-file
- [Option] Specifies a file that contains a CRL in PEM format to use when verifying S/MIME messages.
- smime-encrypt-USER@HOST
- [Option] If this variable is set, messages send to the given receiver are
encrypted before sending. The value of the variable must be set to the
name of a file that contains a certificate in PEM format.
If a message is sent to multiple recipients, each of them for whom a corresponding variable is set will receive an individually encrypted message; other recipients will continue to receive the message in plain text unless the smime-force-encryption variable is set. It is recommended to sign encrypted messages, i.e., to also set the smime-sign variable. content-description-smime-message will be inspected for messages which become encrypted.
- smime-force-encryption
- (Boolean)[Option] Causes Mail to refuse sending unencrypted messages.
- smime-sign
- (Boolean)[Option] S/MIME sign outgoing messages with the user's (from) private key and include the users certificate as a MIME attachment. Signing a message enables a recipient to verify that the sender used a valid certificate, that the email addresses in the certificate match those in the message header and that the message content has not been altered. It does not change the message text, and people will be able to read the message as usual. content-description-smime-signature will be inspected. Also see smime-sign-cert, smime-sign-include-certs and smime-sign-digest.
- smime-sign-cert-USER@HOST, smime-sign-cert
- [Option] Points to a file in PEM format. For the purpose of signing and
decryption this file needs to contain the user's private key, followed by
his certificate.
For message signing ‘
USER@HOST
’ is always derived from the value of from (or, if that contains multiple addresses, sender). For the purpose of encryption the recipients public encryption key (certificate) is expected; the commandcertsave
can be used to save certificates of signed messages (the section Signed and encrypted messages with S/MIME gives some details). This mode of operation is usually driven by the specialized form.When decrypting messages the account is derived from the recipient fields (‘
To:
’ and ‘Cc:
’) of the message, which are searched for addresses for which such a variable is set. Mail always uses the first address that matches, so if the same message is sent to more than one of the user addresses using different encryption keys, decryption might fail.Password-encrypted keys may be used for signing and decryption. Automated password lookup is possible via the “pseudo-hosts” ‘
USER@HOST.smime-cert-key
’ for the private key, and ‘USER@HOST.smime-cert-cert
’ for the certificate stored in the same file. For example, the hypothetical address ‘bob@exam.ple
’ could be driven with a private key / certificate pair path defined in smime-sign-cert-bob@exam.ple, and the needed passwords would then be looked up as ‘bob@exam.ple.smime-cert-key
’ and ‘bob@exam.ple.smime-cert-cert
’. When decrypting the value of from will be tried as a fallback to provide the necessary ‘USER@HOST
’. To include intermediate certificates, use smime-sign-include-certs. The possible password sources are documented in On URL syntax and credential lookup. - smime-sign-digest-USER@HOST, smime-sign-digest
- [Option] Specifies the message digest to use when signing S/MIME messages.
Please remember that for this use case
‘
USER@HOST
’ refers to the variable from (or, if that contains multiple addresses, sender). The available algorithms depend on the used cryptographic library, but at least one usable built-in algorithm is ensured as a default. If possible the standard RFC 5751 will be violated by using ‘SHA512
’ instead of the mandated ‘SHA1
’ due to security concerns. This variable is ignored for very old (released before 2010) cryptographic libraries which do not offer the necessary interface: it will be logged if that happened.Mail will try to add built-in support for the following message digests, names are case-insensitive: ‘
BLAKE2b512
’, ‘BLAKE2s256
’, ‘SHA3-512
’, ‘SHA3-384
’, ‘SHA3-256
’, ‘SHA3-224
’, as well as the widely available ‘SHA512
’, ‘SHA384
’, ‘SHA256
’, ‘SHA224
’, and the proposed insecure ‘SHA1
’, finally ‘MD5
’. More digests may [Option]ally be available through dynamic loading via the OpenSSL function EVP_get_digestbyname(3). - smime-sign-include-certs-USER@HOST, smime-sign-include-certs
- [Option] If used, this is supposed to a consist of a comma-separated list
of files, each of which containing a single certificate in PEM format to
be included in the S/MIME message in addition to the
smime-sign-cert certificate. This can be used to
include intermediate certificates of the certificate authority, in order
to allow the receiver's S/MIME implementation to perform a verification of
the entire certificate chain, starting from a local root certificate, over
the intermediate certificates, down to the
smime-sign-cert. Even though top level certificates
may also be included in the chain, they will not be used for the
verification on the receiver's side.
For the purpose of the mechanisms involved here, ‘
USER@HOST
’ refers to the content of the internal variable from (or, if that contains multiple addresses, sender). The pseudo-host ‘USER@HOST.smime-include-certs
’ will be used for performing password lookups for these certificates, shall they have been given one, therefore the lookup can be automated via the mechanisms described in On URL syntax and credential lookup. - smime-sign-message-digest-USER@HOST, smime-sign-message-digest
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessor(s) of smime-sign-digest.
- smtp
- [Obsolete][Option] To use the built-in SMTP transport, specify a SMTP URL in mta. [v15 behaviour may differ] For compatibility reasons a set smtp is used in preference of mta.
- smtp-auth-USER@HOST, smtp-auth-HOST, smtp-auth
- [Option] Variable chain that controls the SMTP mta
authentication method, possible values are
‘
none
’ ([no v15-compat] default), ‘plain
’ ([v15-compat] default), ‘login
’, [v15-compat] ‘oauthbearer
’ (see FAQ entry But, how about XOAUTH2 / OAUTHBEARER?) as well as [v15-compat] ‘external
’ and ‘externanon
’ for TLS secured connections which pass a client certificate via tls-config-pairs. There may be the [Option]al methods ‘cram-md5
’ and ‘gssapi
’. ‘none
’ and ‘externanon
’ do not need any user credentials, ‘external
’ and ‘gssapi
’ require a user name, and all other methods require a user name and a password. ‘externanon
’ solely builds upon the credentials passed via a client certificate, and is usually the way to go since tested servers do not actually follow RFC 4422 aka RFC 4954, and fail if additional credentials are passed. Also see mta. Note that smtp-auth-HOST is [v15-compat]. ([no v15-compat] Requires smtp-auth-password and smtp-auth-user. Note for smtp-auth-USER@HOST: may override dependent on sender address in the variable from.) - smtp-auth-password
- [Option][no v15-compat] Sets the global fallback password for SMTP authentication. If the authentication method requires a password, but neither smtp-auth-password nor a matching smtp-auth-password-USER@HOST can be found, Mail will ask for a password on the user's terminal.
- smtp-auth-password-USER@HOST
- [no v15-compat] Overrides smtp-auth-password for specific values of sender addresses, dependent upon the variable from.
- smtp-auth-user
- [Option][no v15-compat] Sets the global fallback user name for SMTP authentication. If the authentication method requires a user name, but neither smtp-auth-user nor a matching smtp-auth-user-USER@HOST can be found, Mail will ask for a user name on the user's terminal.
- smtp-auth-user-USER@HOST
- [no v15-compat] Overrides smtp-auth-user for specific values of sender addresses, dependent upon the variable from.
- smtp-hostname
- [Option][v15-compat] Normally Mail uses the variable
from to derive the necessary
‘
USER@HOST
’ information in order to issue a ‘MAIL FROM:<>
’ SMTP mta command. Setting smtp-hostname can be used to use the ‘USER
’ from the SMTP account (mta or the user variable chain) and the given ‘HOST
’ (hostname if the empty string is given, or the local hostname as a last resort). This often allows using an address that is itself valid but hosted by a provider other than from which (in from) the message is sent. Setting this variable also influences generated ‘Message-ID:
’ and ‘Content-ID:
’ header fields. If the [Option]al IDNA support is available (see idna-disable) variable assignment is aborted when a necessary conversion fails. - smtp-use-starttls-USER@HOST, smtp-use-starttls-HOST, smtp-use-starttls
- (Boolean)[Option] Causes Mail to issue a
‘
STARTTLS
’ command to make an SMTP mta session TLS encrypted, i.e., to enable transport layer security. - socket-connect-timeout
- [Option] A positive number that defines the timeout to wait for establishing a socket connection before forcing ^ERR-TIMEDOUT.
- socks-proxy-USER@HOST, socks-proxy-HOST, socks-proxy
- [Option] If set to the URL of a SOCKS5 server then all network activities
are proxied through it, except for the single DNS name lookup necessary to
resolve the proxy URL (unnecessary when given an already resolved IP
address). It is automatically squared with the environment variable
SOCKS5_PROXY
, changing the one will adjust the other. This example creates a local SOCKS5 proxy on port 10000 that forwards to the machine ‘HOST
’ (with identity ‘USER
’), and from which actual network traffic happens:$ ssh -D 10000 USER@HOST $ mail -Ssocks-proxy=[socks5://]localhost:10000 # or =localhost:10000; no local DNS: =127.0.0.1:10000
- spam-interface
- [Option] In order to use any of the spam-related commands (like
spamrate
) the desired spam interface must be defined by setting this variable. Please refer to the manual section Handling spam for the complete picture of spam handling in Mail. All or none of the following interfaces may be available:- ‘
spamc
’ - Interaction with spamc(1)
from the
spamassassin(1)
(SpamAssassin)
suite. Different to the generic filter interface Mail will
automatically add the correct arguments for a given command and has
the necessary knowledge to parse the program's output. A default value
for spamc-command will have been compiled into
the Mail binary if spamc(1)
has been found in
PATH
during compilation. Shall it be necessary to define a specific connection type (rather than using a configuration file for that), the variable spamc-arguments can be used as in for example ‘-d server.example.com -p 783
’. It is also possible to specify a per-user configuration via spamc-user. Note that this interface does not inspect the ‘is-spam
’ flag of a message for the commandspamforget
. - ‘
filter
’ - generic spam filter support via freely configurable hooks. This
interface is meant for programs like
bogofilter(1) and
requires according behaviour in respect to the hooks' exit status for
at least the command
spamrate
(‘0
’ meaning a message is spam, ‘1
’ for non-spam, ‘2
’ for unsure and any other return value indicating a hard error); since the hooks can include shell code snippets diverting behaviour can be intercepted as necessary. The hooks are spamfilter-ham, spamfilter-noham, spamfilter-nospam, spamfilter-rate and spamfilter-spam; the manual section Handling spam contains examples for some programs. The process environment of the hooks will have the variableMAILX_FILENAME_GENERATED
set. Note that spam score support forspamrate
is not supported unless the [Option]tional regular expression support is available and the spamfilter-rate-scanscore variable is set.
- ‘
- spam-maxsize
- [Option] Messages that exceed this size will not be passed through to the configured spam-interface. If unset or 0, the default of 420000 bytes is used.
- spamc-command
- [Option] The path to the spamc(1)
program for the ‘
spamc
’ spam-interface. Note that the path is not expanded, but used “as is”. A fallback path will have been compiled into the Mail binary if the executable had been found during compilation. - spamc-arguments
- [Option] Even though Mail deals with most arguments for the
‘
spamc
’ spam-interface automatically, it may at least sometimes be desirable to specify connection-related ones via this variable, for example ‘-d server.example.com -p 783
’. - spamc-user
- [Option] Specify a username for per-user configuration files for the
‘
spamc
’ spam-interface. If this is set to the empty string then Mail will use the name of the current user. - spamfilter-ham, spamfilter-noham, spamfilter-nospam, spamfilter-rate, spamfilter-spam
- [Option] Command and argument hooks for the
‘
filter
’ spam-interface. The manual section Handling spam contains examples for some programs. - spamfilter-rate-scanscore
- [Option] Because of the generic nature of the
‘
filter
’ spam-interface spam scores are not supported for it by default, but if the [Option]nal regular expression support is available then setting this variable can be used to overcome this restriction. It is interpreted as follows: first a number (digits) is parsed that must be followed by a semicolon ‘;
’ and an extended regular expression. Then the latter is used to parse the first output line of the spamfilter-rate hook, and, in case the evaluation is successful, the group that has been specified via the number is interpreted as a floating point scan score. - ssl-ca-dir-USER@HOST, ssl-ca-dir-HOST, ssl-ca-dir, ssl-ca-file-USER@HOST, ssl-ca-file-HOST, ssl-ca-file
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessors of tls-ca-file, tls-ca-dir.
- ssl-ca-flags-USER@HOST, ssl-ca-flags-HOST, ssl-ca-flags
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessor of tls-ca-flags.
- ssl-ca-no-defaults-USER@HOST, ssl-ca-no-defaults-HOST, ssl-ca-no-defaults
- [Obsolete](Boolean)[Option] Predecessor of tls-ca-no-defaults.
- ssl-cert-USER@HOST, ssl-cert-HOST, ssl-cert
- [Obsolete][Option] Please use the
Certificate
slot of tls-config-pairs. - ssl-cipher-list-USER@HOST, ssl-cipher-list-HOST, ssl-cipher-list
- [Obsolete][Option] Please use the
CipherString
slot of tls-config-pairs. - ssl-config-file
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessor of tls-config-file.
- ssl-config-module-USER@HOST, ssl-config-module-HOST, ssl-config-module
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessor of tls-config-module.
- ssl-config-pairs-USER@HOST, ssl-config-pairs-HOST, ssl-config-pairs
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessor of tls-config-pairs.
- ssl-crl-dir, ssl-crl-file
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessors of tls-crl-dir, tls-crl-file.
- ssl-curves-USER@HOST, ssl-curves-HOST, ssl-curves
- [Obsolete][Option] Please use the
Curves
slot of tls-config-pairs. - ssl-features
- [Obsolete][Option](Read-only) Predecessor of tls-features.
- ssl-key-USER@HOST, ssl-key-HOST, ssl-key
- [Obsolete][Option] Please use the
PrivateKey
slot of tls-config-pairs. - ssl-method-USER@HOST, ssl-method-HOST, ssl-method
- [Obsolete][Option] Please use the
Protocol
slot of tls-config-pairs. - ssl-protocol-USER@HOST, ssl-protocol-HOST, ssl-protocol
- [Obsolete][Option] Please use the
Protocol
slot of tls-config-pairs. - ssl-rand-file
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessor of tls-rand-file.
- ssl-verify-USER@HOST, ssl-verify-HOST, ssl-verify
- [Obsolete][Option] Predecessor of tls-verify.
- stealthmua
- If only set without an assigned value, then this setting inhibits the
generation of the ‘
Message-ID:
’, ‘Content-ID:
’ and ‘User-Agent:
’ header fields that include obvious references to Mail. There are two pitfalls associated with this: First, the message id of outgoing messages is not known anymore. Second, an expert may still use the remaining information in the header to track down the originating mail user agent. If set to the value ‘noagent
’, then the mentioned ‘Message-ID:
’ and ‘Content-ID:
’ suppression does not occur. - system-mailrc
- (Read-only) The compiled in path of the system wide initialization file one of the Resource files: mail.rc.
- termcap
- ([Option]) This specifies a comma-separated list of
Terminal Information Library (libterminfo,
-lterminfo) and/or Termcap Access Library
(libtermcap, -ltermcap) capabilities (see
On terminal
control and line editor, escape commas with reverse solidus
‘
\
’) to be used to overwrite or define entries. Note this variable will only be queried once at program startup and can thus only be specified in resource files or on the command line. It will always be inspected, regardless of whether features denotes termcap/terminfo library support via ‘,+termcap,
’.String capabilities form ‘
cap=value
’ pairs and are expected unless noted otherwise. Numerics have to be notated as ‘cap#number
’ where the number is expected in normal decimal notation. Finally, booleans do not have any value but indicate a true or false state simply by being defined or not; this indeed means that Mail does not support undefining an existing boolean. String capability values will undergo some expansions before use: for one notations like ‘^LETTER
’ stand for ‘control-LETTER
’, and for clarification purposes ‘\E
’ can be used to specify ‘escape
’ (the control notation ‘^[
’ could lead to misreadings when a left bracket follows, which it does for the standard CSI sequence); finally three letter octal sequences, as in ‘\061
’, are supported. To specify that a terminal supports 256-colours, and to define sequences that home the cursor and produce an audible bell, one might write:? set termcap='Co#256,home=\E[H,bel=^G'
The following terminal capabilities are or may be meaningful for the operation of the built-in line editor or Mail in general:
am
auto_right_margin
: boolean which indicates if the right margin needs special treatment; thexenl
capability is related, for more seeCOLUMNS
. This capability is only used when backed by library support.clear
orcl
clear_screen
: clear the screen and home cursor. (Will be simulated viaho
pluscd
.)colors
orCo
max_colors
: numeric capability specifying the maximum number of colours. Note that Mail does not actually care about the terminal beside that, but always emits ANSI / ISO 6429 escape sequences; also seecolour
.cr
carriage_return
: move to the first column in the current row. The default built-in fallback is ‘\r
’.cub1
orle
cursor_left
: move the cursor left one space (non-destructively). The default built-in fallback is ‘\b
’.cuf1
ornd
cursor_right
: move the cursor right one space (non-destructively). The default built-in fallback is ‘\E[C
’, which is used by most terminals. Less often occur ‘\EC
’ and ‘\EOC
’.ed
orcd
clr_eos
: clear the screen.el
orce
clr_eol
: clear to the end of line. (Will be simulated viach
plus repetitions of space characters.)home
orho
cursor_home
: home cursor.hpa
orch
column_address
: move the cursor (to the given column parameter) in the current row. (Will be simulated viacr
plusnd
.)rmcup
orte
/smcup
orti
exit_ca_mode
andenter_ca_mode
, respectively: exit and enter the alternative screen ca-mode, effectively turning Mail into a fullscreen application. This must be enabled explicitly by setting termcap-ca-mode.smkx
orks
/rmkx
orke
keypad_xmit
andkeypad_local
, respectively: enable and disable the keypad. This is always enabled if available, because it seems even keyboards without keypads generate other key codes for, e.g., cursor keys in that case, and only if enabled we see the codes that we are interested in.xenl
orxn
eat_newline_glitch
: boolean which indicates whether a newline written in the last column of anauto_right_margin
indicating terminal is ignored. With it the full terminal width is available even on autowrap terminals. This will be inspected even without ‘,+termcap,
’ features.
Many more capabilities which describe key-sequences are documented for
bind
. - termcap-ca-mode
- [Option] Allow usage of the
exit_ca_mode
andenter_ca_mode
termcapabilities in order to enter an alternative exclusive screen, the so-called ca-mode; this usually requires special configuration of thePAGER
, also dependent on the value of crt. Note this variable will only be queried once at program startup and can thus only be specified in resource files or on the command line. - termcap-disable
- [Option] Disable any interaction with a terminal control library. If set only some generic fallback built-ins and possibly the content of termcap describe the terminal to Mail. Note this variable will only be queried once at program startup and can thus only be specified in resource files or on the command line.
- tls-ca-dir-USER@HOST, tls-ca-dir-HOST, tls-ca-dir, tls-ca-file-USER@HOST, tls-ca-file-HOST, tls-ca-file
- [Option] Directory and file, respectively, for pools of trusted CA certificates in PEM (Privacy Enhanced Mail) format, for the purpose of verification of TLS server certificates. Concurrent use is possible, the file is loaded once needed first, the directory lookup is performed anew as a last resort whenever necessary. The CA certificate pool built into the TLS library can be disabled via tls-ca-no-defaults, further fine-tuning is possible via tls-ca-flags. The directory search requires special filename conventions, please see SSL_CTX_load_verify_locations(3) and verify(1) (or c_rehash(1)).
- tls-ca-flags-USER@HOST, tls-ca-flags-HOST, tls-ca-flags
- [Option] Can be used to fine-tune behaviour of the X509 CA certificate
storage, and the certificate verification that is used (also see
tls-verify). The value is expected to consist of a
comma-separated list of configuration directives, with any intervening
whitespace being ignored. The directives directly map to flags that can be
passed to
X509_STORE_set_flags(3),
which are usually defined in a file
openssl/x509_vfy.h, and the availability of which
depends on the used TLS library version: a directive without mapping is
ignored (error log subject to debug). Directives
currently understood (case-insensitively) include:
no-alt-chains
- If the initial chain is not trusted, do not attempt to build an
alternative chain. Setting this flag will make OpenSSL certificate
verification match that of older OpenSSL versions, before automatic
building and checking of alternative chains has been implemented; also
see
trusted-first
. no-check-time
- Do not check certificate/CRL validity against current time.
partial-chain
- By default partial, incomplete chains which cannot be verified up to the chain top, a self-signed root certificate, will not verify. With this flag set, a chain succeeds to verify if at least one signing certificate of the chain is in any of the configured trusted stores of CA certificates. The OpenSSL manual page SSL_CTX_load_verify_locations(3) gives some advise how to manage your own trusted store of CA certificates.
strict
- Disable workarounds for broken certificates.
trusted-first
- Try building a chain using issuers in the trusted store first to avoid
problems with server-sent legacy intermediate certificates. Newer
versions of OpenSSL support alternative chain checking and enable it
by default, resulting in the same behaviour; also see
no-alt-chains
.
- tls-ca-no-defaults-USER@HOST, tls-ca-no-defaults-HOST, tls-ca-no-defaults
- (Boolean)[Option] Do not load the default CA locations that are built into the used to TLS library to verify TLS server certificates.
- tls-config-file
- [Option] If this variable is set
CONF_modules_load_file(3)
(if announced via
‘
,+modules-load-file,
’ in tls-features) is used to allow resource file based configuration of the TLS library. This happens once the library is used first, which may also be early during startup (logged with verbose)! If a non-empty value is given then the given file, after performing Filename transformations, will be used instead of the TLS libraries global default, and it is an error if the file cannot be loaded. The application name will always be passed as ‘mail
’. Some TLS libraries support application-specific configuration via resource files loaded like this, please see tls-config-module. - tls-config-module-USER@HOST, tls-config-module-HOST, tls-config-module
- [Option] If file based application-specific configuration via
tls-config-file is available, announced as
‘
,+ctx-config,
’ by tls-features, indicating availability of SSL_CTX_config(3), then, it becomes possible to use a central TLS configuration file for all programs, including mail, for example# Register a configuration section for mail mail = mailx_master # The top configuration section creates a relation # in between dynamic SSL configuration and an actual # program specific configuration section [mailx_master] ssl_conf = mailx_tls_config # And that program specific configuration section now # can map diverse tls-config-module names to sections, # as in: tls-config-module=account_xy [mailx_tls_config] account_xy = mailx_account_xy account_yz = mailx_account_yz [mailx_account_xy] MinProtocol = TLSv1.2 Curves=P-521 [mailx_account_yz] CipherString = TLSv1.2:!aNULL:!eNULL: MinProtocol = TLSv1.1 Options = Bugs
- tls-config-pairs-USER@HOST, tls-config-pairs-HOST, tls-config-pairs
- [Option] The value of this variable chain will be interpreted as a
comma-separated list of directive/value pairs. Directives and values need
to be separated by equals signs ‘
=
’, any whitespace surrounding pair members is removed. Keys are (usually) case-insensitive. Different to when placing these pairs in a tls-config-module section of a tls-config-file, commas ‘,
’ need to be escaped with a reverse solidus ‘\
’ when included in pairs; also different: if the equals sign ‘=
’ is preceded with an asterisk ‘*
’ Filename transformations will be performed on the value; it is an error if these fail. Unless proper support is announced by tls-features (‘,+conf-ctx,
’) only the keys below are supported, otherwise the pairs will be used directly as arguments to the function SSL_CONF_cmd(3).Certificate
- Filename of a TLS client certificate (chain) required by some servers.
Fallback support via
SSL_CTX_use_certificate_chain_file(3).
Filename
transformations are performed.
PrivateKey
will be set to the same value if not initialized explicitly. Some services support so-called ‘external
’ authentication if a TLS client certificate was successfully presented during connection establishment (“connecting is authenticating”). CipherString
- A list of ciphers for TLS connections, see
ciphers(1). By default no
list of ciphers is set, resulting in a
Protocol
-specific list of ciphers (the protocol standards define lists of acceptable ciphers; possibly cramped by the used TLS library). Fallback support via SSL_CTX_set_cipher_list(3). Ciphersuites
- A list of ciphers used for TLSv1.3 connections, see
ciphers(1). These will be
joined onto the list of ciphers from
CipherString
. Available if tls-features announces ‘,+ctx-set-ciphersuites,
’, as necessary via SSL_CTX_set_ciphersuites(3). Curves
- A list of supported elliptic curves, if applicable. By default no curves are set. Fallback support via SSL_CTX_set1_curves_list(3), if available.
MaxProtocol
,MinProtocol
- The maximum and minimum supported TLS versions, respectively.
Available if tls-features announces
‘
,+ctx-set-maxmin-proto,
’, as necessary via SSL_CTX_set_max_proto_version(3) and SSL_CTX_set_min_proto_version(3); these fallbacks use an internal parser which understands the strings ‘SSLv3
’, ‘TLSv1
’, ‘TLSv1.1
’, ‘TLSv1.2
’, ‘TLSv1.3
’, and the special value ‘None
’, which disables the given limit. Options
- Various flags to set. Fallback via
SSL_CTX_set_options(3),
in which case any other value but (exactly)
‘
Bugs
’ results in an error. PrivateKey
- Filename of the private key in PEM format of a TLS client certificate.
If unset, the value of
Certificate
is used. Filename transformations are performed. Fallback via SSL_CTX_use_PrivateKey_file(3). Protocol
- The used TLS protocol. If tls-features announces
‘
,+conf-ctx,
’ or ‘ctx-set-maxmin-proto
’ then usingMaxProtocol
andMinProtocol
is preferable. Fallback is SSL_CTX_set_options(3), driven via an internal parser which understands the strings ‘SSLv3
’, ‘TLSv1
’, ‘TLSv1.1
’, ‘TLSv1.2
’, ‘TLSv1.3
’, and the special value ‘ALL
’. Multiple protocols may be given as a comma-separated list, any whitespace is ignored, an optional plus sign ‘+
’ prefix enables, a hyphen-minus ‘-
’ prefix disables a protocol, so that ‘-ALL, TLSv1.2
’ enables only the TLSv1.2 protocol.
- tls-crl-dir, tls-crl-file
- [Option] Specify a directory / a file, respectively, that contains a CRL in PEM format to use when verifying TLS server certificates.
- tls-features
- [Option](Read-only) This expands to a comma-separated list of the TLS
library identity and optional features. To ease substring matching the
string starts and ends with a comma. Currently supported identities are
‘
libressl
’ (LibreSSL) , ‘libssl-0x30000
’ (OpenSSL v3.0.0 series), ‘libssl-0x10100
’ (OpenSSL v1.1.x series) and ‘libssl-0x10000
’ (elder OpenSSL series, other clones). Optional features are preceded with a plus sign ‘+
’ when available, and with a hyphen-minus ‘-
’ otherwise.Currently known features are ‘
conf-ctx
’ (tls-config-pairs), ‘ctx-config
’ (tls-config-module), ‘ctx-set-ciphersuites
’ (Ciphersuites
slot of tls-config-pairs), ‘ctx-set-maxmin-proto
’ (tls-config-pairs), ‘modules-load-file
’ (tls-config-file), and ‘tls-rand-file
’ (tls-rand-file). - tls-fingerprint-USER@HOST, tls-fingerprint-HOST, tls-fingerprint
- [Option] It is possible to replace the verification of the connection peer
certificate against the entire local pool of CAs (for more see
Encrypted network
communication) with the comparison against a precalculated certificate
message digest, the so-called fingerprint, to be specified as the used
tls-fingerprint-digest. This fingerprint can for
example be calculated with
‘
’.tls
fingerprint HOST - tls-fingerprint-digest-USER@HOST, tls-fingerprint-digest-HOST, tls-fingerprint-digest
- [Option] The message digest to be used when creating TLS certificate
fingerprints, the defaults, if available, in test order, being
‘
BLAKE2s256
’, ‘SHA256
’. For the complete list of digest algorithms refer to smime-sign-digest. - tls-rand-file
- [Option] If tls-features announces
‘
,+tls-rand-file,
’ then this will be queried to find a file with random entropy data which can be used to seed the P(seudo)R(andom)N(umber)G(enerator), see RAND_load_file(3). The default filename (RAND_file_name(3), normally ~/.rnd) will be used if this variable is not set or empty, or if the Filename transformations fail. Shall seeding the PRNG have been successful, RAND_write_file(3) will be called to update the entropy. Remarks: libraries which do not announce this feature seed the PRNG by other means. - tls-verify-USER@HOST, tls-verify-HOST, tls-verify
- [Option] Variable chain that sets the action to be performed if an error
occurs during TLS server certificate validation against the specified or
default trust stores tls-ca-dir,
tls-ca-file, or the TLS library built-in defaults
(unless usage disallowed via tls-ca-no-defaults),
and as fine-tuned via tls-ca-flags. Valid
(case-insensitive) values are
‘
strict
’ (fail and close connection immediately), ‘ask
’ (ask whether to continue on standard input), ‘warn
’ (show a warning and continue), ‘ignore
’ (do not perform validation). The default is ‘ask
’. - toplines
- If defined, gives the number of lines of a message to be displayed with
the command
top
; if unset, the first five lines are printed, if set to 0 the variable screen is inspected. If the value is negative then its absolute value will be used for unsigned right shifting (seevexpr
) the screen height. - topsqueeze
- (Boolean) If set then the
top
command series will strip adjacent empty lines and quotations. - ttycharset
- The character set of the terminal Mail operates on, and the one and only
supported character set that Mail can use if no character set conversion
capabilities have been compiled into it, in which case it defaults to
ISO-8859-1. Otherwise it defaults to UTF-8. Sufficient locale support
provided the default will be preferably deduced from the locale
environment if that is set (for example
LC_CTYPE
, see there for more); runtime locale changes will be reflected by ttycharset except during the program startup phase and if-S
had been used to freeze the given value. Refer to the section Character sets for the complete picture about character sets. - typescript-mode
- (Boolean) A special multiplex variable that disables all variables and settings which result in behaviour that interferes with running Mail in script(1); it sets colour-disable, line-editor-disable and (before startup completed only) termcap-disable. Unsetting it does not restore the former state of the covered settings.
- umask
- For a safe-by-default policy the process file mode creation mask
umask(2) will be set to
‘
0077
’ on program startup after the resource files have been loaded, and unless this variable is set. By assigning this an empty value the active setting will not be changed, otherwise the given value will be made the new file mode creation mask. Child processes inherit the file mode creation mask of their parent. - user-HOST, user
- [v15-compat] Variable chain that sets a global fallback user name, used in case none has been given in the protocol and account-specific URL. This variable defaults to the name of the user who runs Mail.
- v15-compat
- Enable upward compatibility with Mail version 15.0 in respect to which
configuration options are available and how they are handled. If set to a
non-empty value the command modifier
wysh
is implied and thus enforces Shell-style argument quoting over Old-style argument quoting for all commands which support both. This manual uses [v15-compat] and [no v15-compat] to refer to the new and the old way of doing things, respectively. - verbose
- Verbose mode enables logging of informational context messages.
Historically a (Boolean) variable, this can either be set multiple times
(what the command line option
-v
uses), or be assigned a numeric value in order to increase verbosity. Assigning the value 0 disables verbosity and thus (almost) equalsunset
. The maximum number is 3. Also see debug. - version, version-date, version-hexnum, version-major, version-minor, version-update
- (Read-only) Mail version information: the first variable is a string with
the complete version identification, the second the release date in ISO
8601 notation without time. The third is a 32-bit hexadecimal number with
the upper 8 bits storing the major, followed by the minor and update
version numbers which occupy 12 bits each. The latter three variables
contain only decimal digits: the major, minor and update version numbers.
The output of the command
version
will include this information. - writebackedited
- If this variable is set messages modified using the
edit
orvisual
commands are written back to the current folder when it is quit; it is only honoured for writable folders in MBOX format, though. Note that the editor will be pointed to the raw message content in that case, i.e., neither MIME decoding nor decryption will have been performed, and proper mbox-rfc4155 ‘From_
’ quoting of newly added or edited content is also left as an exercise to the user.
ENVIRONMENT
The term “environment variable” should be considered
an indication that these variables are either standardized as vivid parts of
process environments, or that they are commonly found in there. The process
environment is inherited from the
sh(1) once Mail is started, and unless
otherwise explicitly noted handling of the following variables transparently
integrates into that of the
INTERNAL VARIABLES from Mail's
point of view. This means they can be managed via
set
and unset
, causing
automatic program environment updates (to be inherited by newly created
child processes).
In order to integrate other environment variables equally they
need to be imported (linked) with the command
environ
. This command can also be used to set and
unset non-integrated environment variables from scratch, sufficient system
support provided. The following example, applicable to a POSIX shell, sets
the COLUMNS
environment variable for Mail only, and
beforehand exports the EDITOR
in order to affect any
further processing in the running shell:
$ EDITOR="vim -u ${HOME}/.vimrc" $ export EDITOR $ COLUMNS=80 mail -R
COLUMNS
- The user's preferred width in column positions for the terminal screen.
Queried and used once on program startup in interactive or batch
(
-#
) mode, actively managed for child processes and the MLE (see On terminal control and line editor) in interactive mode thereafter. Non-interactive mode always uses, and the fallback default is a compile-time constant, by default 80 columns. If in batch modeCOLUMNS
andLINES
are both set but not both are usable (empty, not a number, or 0) at program startup, then the real terminal screen size will be (tried to be) determined once. (Normally the sh(1) manages these variables, and unsets them for pipe specifications etc.) DEAD
- The name of the (mailbox)
folder
to use for saving aborted messages if save is set; this defaults to ~/dead.letter. If the variable debug is set no output will be generated, otherwise the contents of the file will be replaced. Except shell globs Filename transformations (also seefolder
) will be performed. EDITOR
- Pathname of the text editor to use for the
edit
command and~e
(see COMMAND ESCAPES);VISUAL
is used for a more display oriented editor. HOME
- The user's home directory. This variable is only used when it resides in
the process environment. The calling user's home directory will be used
instead if this directory does not exist, is not accessible or cannot be
read; it will always be used for the root user. (No test for being
writable is performed to allow usage by non-privileged users within
read-only jails, but dependent on settings this directory is a default
write target for, for example,
DEAD
,MBOX
and more.) LC_ALL
,LC_CTYPE
,LANG
- [Option] The (names in lookup order of the)
locale(7) (and / or see
setlocale(3)) which indicates
the used Character sets. Runtime
changes trigger automatic updates of the entire locale system, which
includes updating ttycharset (except during startup
if the variable has been frozen via
-S
). LINES
- The user's preferred number of lines for the terminal screen. The
behaviour is as described for
COLUMNS
, yet the compile-time constant used in non-interactive mode and as a fallback defaults to 24 (lines). LISTER
- Pathname of the directory lister to use in the
folders
command when operating on local mailboxes. Default is ls(1) (path search throughSHELL
). LOGNAME
- Upon startup Mail will actively ensure that this variable refers to the name of the user who runs Mail, in order to be able to pass a verified name to any newly created child process.
MAIL
- Is used as the user's primary system mailbox unless inbox is set. If the environmental fallback is also not set, a built-in compile-time default is used. This is assumed to be an absolute pathname.
MAILCAPS
- [Option] Override the default path search of
The Mailcap files: any
existing file therein will be loaded in sequence, appending any content to
the list of MIME type handler directives. The RFC 1524 standard imposed
default value is assigned otherwise:
‘
~/.mailcap:/etc/mailcap:/usr/etc/mailcap:/usr/local/etc/mailcap
’. (The default value is a compile-time [Option].) MAILRC
- Is used as a startup file instead of ~/.mailrc if
set. In order to avoid side-effects from configuration files scripts
should either set this variable to /dev/null or
the
-:
command line option should be used. MAILX_NO_SYSTEM_RC
- If this variable is set then reading of mail.rc
(aka system-mailrc) at startup is inhibited, i.e.,
the same effect is achieved as if Mail had been started up with the option
-:
(and according argument) or-n
. This variable is only used when it resides in the process environment. MBOX
- The name of the user's secondary
mailbox file. A logical subset of the special
Filename
transformations (also see
folder
) are supported. The default is ~/mbox. Traditionally this MBOX is used as the file to save messages from the primary system mailbox that have been read. Also see Message states. NETRC
- [v15-compat][Option] This variable overrides the default location of the user's ~/.netrc file.
PAGER
- Pathname of the program to use for backing the command
more
, and when the crt variable enforces usage of a pager for output. The default paginator is more(1) (path search throughSHELL
).Mail inspects the contents of this variable: if its contains the string “less” then a non-existing environment variable
LESS
will be set to (the portable) ‘RI
’, likewise for “lv”LV
will optionally be set to ‘-c
’. Also see colour-pager. PATH
- A colon-separated list of directories that is searched by the shell when
looking for commands, for example
‘
/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin
’. POSIXLY_CORRECT
- This environment entry is automatically squared with posix.
SHELL
- The shell to use for the commands
!
,shell
, the~!
COMMAND ESCAPES and when starting subprocesses. A default shell is used if this environment variable is not defined. SOCKS5_PROXY
- This environment entry is automatically squared with socks-proxy.
SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH
- Specifies a time in seconds since the Unix epoch (1970-01-01) to be used
in place of the current time. This variable is looked up upon program
startup, and its existence will switch Mail to a reproducible mode
(https://reproducible-builds.org)
which uses deterministic random numbers, a special fixated pseudo
LOGNAME
and more. This operation mode is used for development and by software packagers. [v15 behaviour may differ] Currently an invalid setting is only ignored, rather than causing a program abortion.$ SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH=`date +%s` mail
TERM
- [Option] The terminal type for which output is to be prepared. For extended colour and font control please refer to Coloured display, and for terminal management in general to On terminal control and line editor.
TMPDIR
- Except for the root user this variable defines the directory for temporary files to be used instead of /tmp (or the given compile-time constant) if set, existent, accessible as well as read- and writable. This variable is only used when it resides in the process environment, but Mail will ensure at startup that this environment variable is updated to contain a usable temporary directory.
USER
- Identical to
LOGNAME
(see there), but this variable is not standardized, should therefore not be used, and is only corrected if already set. VISUAL
- Pathname of the text editor to use for the
visual
command and~v
(see COMMAND ESCAPES);EDITOR
is used for a less display oriented editor.
FILES
- ~/.mailcap, /etc/mailcap
- [Option] Personal and system-wide MIME type handler definition files, see
The Mailcap files. (The shown
names are part of the RFC 1524 standard search path
MAILCAPS
.) - ~/.mailrc, mail.rc
- User-specific and system-wide files giving initial commands, the Resource files. (The used filenames come from MAILRC and system-mailrc, respectively.)
- ~/mbox
- The default value for
MBOX
. - ~/.mime.types, /etc/mime.types
- Personal and system-wide MIME types, see The mime.types files.
- ~/.netrc
- [v15-compat][Option] The default location of the user's
.netrc file – the section
The .netrc file documents the
file format. The used path can be set via
NETRC
. - /dev/null
- The data sink null(4).
- ~/.rnd
- [Option] Possible location for persistent random entropy seed storage, see tls-rand-file.
Resource files
Upon startup Mail reads in several resource files, in order:
- mail.rc
- System wide initialization file (system-mailrc).
Reading of this file can be suppressed, either by using the
-:
(and according argument) or-n
command line options, or by setting the ENVIRONMENT variableMAILX_NO_SYSTEM_RC
. - ~/.mailrc
- File giving initial commands. A different file can be chosen by setting
the ENVIRONMENT variable
MAILRC
. Reading of this file can be suppressed with the-:
command line option. - mailx-extra-rc
- Defines a startup file to be read after all other resource files. It can be used to specify settings that are not understood by other mailx(1) implementations, for example.
The content of these files is interpreted as follows:
- The whitespace characters space, tabulator and newline, as well as those defined by the variable ifs, are removed from the beginning and end of input lines.
- Empty lines are ignored.
- Any other line is interpreted as a command. It may be spread over multiple
input lines if the newline character is “escaped” by placing
a reverse solidus character ‘
\
’ as the last character of the line; whereas any leading whitespace of follow lines is ignored, trailing whitespace before a escaped newline remains in the input. - If the line (content) starts with the number sign
‘
#
’ then it is a comment-command and also ignored. (The comment-command is a real command, which does nothing, and therefore the usual follow lines mechanism applies!)
Errors while loading these files are subject to the settings of
errexit and posix. More files
with syntactically equal content can be source
ed.
The following, saved in a file, would be an examplary content:
# This line is a comment command. And y\ es, it is really continued here. set debug \ verbose set editheaders
The mime.types files
As stated in
HTML mail and MIME
attachments Mail needs to learn about MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail
Extensions) media types in order to classify message and attachment content.
One source for them are mime.types files, the
loading of which can be controlled by setting the variable
mimetypes-load-control. Another is the command
mimetype
, which also offers access to Mails MIME
type cache. mime.types files have the following
syntax:
type/subtype extension [extension ...] # For example text/html html htm
where ‘type/subtype
’ define
the MIME media type, as standardized in RFC 2046:
‘type
’ is used to declare the general
type of data, while the ‘subtype
’
specifies a specific format for that type of data. One or multiple filename
‘extension
’s, separated by whitespace,
can be bound to the media type format. Comments may be introduced anywhere
on a line with a number sign ‘#
’,
causing the remaining line to be discarded. Mail also supports an extended,
non-portable syntax in especially crafted files, which can be loaded via the
alternative value syntax of mimetypes-load-control,
and prepends an optional
‘type-marker
’:
[type-marker ]type/subtype extension
[extension ...]
The following type markers are supported:
- ?
- Treat message parts with this content as plain text.
- ?t
- The same as plain ?.
- ?h
- Treat message parts with this content as HTML tagsoup. If the [Option]al HTML-tagsoup-to-text converter is not available treat the content as plain text instead.
- ?H
- Likewise ?h, but instead of falling back to plain text require an explicit content handler to be defined.
- ?q
- If no handler can be found a text message is displayed which says so. This can be annoying, for example signatures serve a contextual purpose, their content is of no use by itself. This marker will avoid displaying the text message.
Further reading: for sending messages:
mimetype
,
mime-allow-text-controls,
mimetypes-load-control. For reading etc. messages:
HTML mail and MIME
attachments, The Mailcap
files, mimetype
,
mime-counter-evidence,
mimetypes-load-control,
pipe-TYPE/SUBTYPE,
pipe-EXTENSION.
The Mailcap files
[Option] RFC 1524 defines a “User Agent Configuration
Mechanism” to be used to inform mail user agent programs about the
locally installed facilities for handling various data formats, i.e., about
commands and how they can be used to display, edit et cetera MIME part
contents, as well as a default path search that includes multiple possible
locations of resource files, and the MAILCAPS
environment variable to overwrite that. Handlers found from doing the path
search will be cached, the command mailcap
operates
on that cache, and the variable mailcap-disable will
suppress automatic loading, and usage of any mailcap handlers.
HTML mail and MIME
attachments gives a general overview of how MIME types are handled.
“Mailcap” files consist of a set of newline
separated entries. Comment lines start with a number sign
‘#
’ (in the first column!) and are
ignored. Empty lines are ignored. All other lines are interpreted as mailcap
entries. An entry definition may be split over multiple lines by placing the
reverse solidus character ‘\
’ last in
all but the final line. The standard does not specify how leading whitespace
of successive lines is to be treated, therefore they are retained.
“Mailcap” entries consist of a number of semicolon
‘;
’ separated fields. The first two
fields are mandatory and must occur in the specified order, the remaining
fields are optional and may appear in any order. Leading and trailing
whitespace of field content is ignored (removed). The reverse solidus
‘\
’ character can be used to escape
any following character including semicolon and itself in the content of the
second field, and in value parts of any optional key/value field.
The first field defines the MIME
‘TYPE/SUBTYPE
’ the entry is about to
handle (case-insensitively). If the subtype is specified as an asterisk
‘*
’ the entry is meant to match all
subtypes of the named type, e.g.,
‘audio/*
’ would match any audio type.
The second field is the view
shell command used to
display MIME parts of the given type.
Data consuming shell commands will be fed message (MIME part) data
on standard input unless one or more instances of the (unquoted) string
‘%s
’ are used: these formats will be
replaced with a temporary file(name) that has been prefilled with the parts
data. Data producing shell commands are expected to generata data on their
standard output unless that format is used. In all cases any given
‘%s
’ format is replaced with a
properly shell quoted filename. When a command requests a temporary file via
‘%s
’ then that will be removed again,
as if the x-mailx-tmpfile
and
x-mailx-tmpfile-fill
flags had been set; unless the
command requests x-mailx-async
the
x-mailx-tmpfile-unlink
flag is also implied; see
below for more.
Optional fields define single-word flags (case-insensitive), or
key / value pairs consisting of a case-insensitive keyword, an equals sign
‘=
’, and a shell command; whitespace
surrounding the equals sign is removed. Optional fields include the
following:
compose
- A program that can be used to compose a new body or body part in the given format. (Currently unused.)
composetyped
- Similar to the
compose
field, but is to be used when the composing program needs to specify the ‘Content-type:
’ header field to be applied to the composed data. (Currently unused.) copiousoutput
- A flag field which indicates that the output of the
view
command is integrable into Mails normal visual display. It is mutually exclusive withneedsterminal
. description
- A textual description that describes this type of data. The text may
optionally be enclosed within double quotation marks
‘
"
’. edit
- A program that can be used to edit a body or body part in the given format. (Currently unused.)
nametemplate
- This field specifies a filename format for the
‘
%s
’ format used in the shell command fields, in which ‘%s
’ will be replaced by a random string. (The filename is also stored in and passed to subprocesses viaMAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY
.) The standard says this is “only expected to be relevant in environments where filename extensions are meaningful”, and so this field is ignored unless the ‘%s
’ is a prefix, optionally followed by (ASCII) alphabetic and numeric characters, the underscore and the period. For example, to specify that a JPG file is to be passed to an image viewer with a name ending in ‘.jpg
’, ‘nametemplate=%s.jpg
’ can be used. needsterminal
- This flag field indicates that the given shell command must be run on an
interactive terminal. Mail will temporarily release the terminal to the
given command in interactive mode, in non-interactive mode this entry will
be entirely ignored; this flag implies
x-mailx-noquote
. print
- A program that can be used to print a message or body part in the given format. (Currently unused.)
test
- Specifies a program to be run to test some condition, for example, the
machine architecture, or the window system in use, to determine whether or
not this mailcap entry applies. If the test fails, a subsequent mailcap
entry should be sought; also see
x-mailx-test-once
. Standard I/O of the test program is redirected from and to /dev/null, and the format ‘%s
’ is not supported (the data does not yet exist). textualnewlines
- A flag field which indicates that this type of data is line-oriented and
that, if encoded in ‘
base64
’, all newlines should be converted to canonical form (CRLF) before encoding, and will be in that form after decoding. (Currently unused.) x11-bitmap
- Names a file, in X11 bitmap (xbm) format, which points to an appropriate icon to be used to visually denote the presence of this kind of data. This field is not used by Mail.
x-mailx-async
- Extension flag field that denotes that the given
view
command shall be executed asynchronously, without blocking Mail. Cannot be used in conjunction withneedsterminal
; the standard output of the command will go to /dev/null. x-mailx-noquote
- An extension flag field that indicates that even a
copiousoutput
view
command shall not be used when quoteing messages, as it would by default. x-mailx-test-once
- Extension flag which denotes whether the given
test
command shall be evaluated once only with its exit status being cached. This is handy if some global unchanging condition is to be queried, like “running under the X Window System”. x-mailx-tmpfile
- Extension flag field that requests creation of a zero-sized temporary
file, the name of which is to be placed in the environment variable
MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY
. It is an error to use this flag with commands that include a ‘%s
’ format (because that is implemented by means of this temporary file). x-mailx-tmpfile-fill
- Normally the MIME part content is passed to the handler via standard
input; if this flag is set then the data will instead be written into the
implied
x-mailx-tmpfile
. In order to cause deletion of the temporary file you will have to setx-mailx-tmpfile-unlink
explicitly! It is an error to use this flag with commands that include a ‘%s
’ format. x-mailx-tmpfile-unlink
- Extension flag field that requests that the temporary file shall be
deleted automatically when the command loop is entered again at latest. It
is an error to use this flag with commands that include a
‘
%s
’ format, or in conjunction withx-mailx-async
.x-mailx-tmpfile
is implied. x-mailx-last-resort
- An extension flag that indicates that this handler shall only be used as a last resort, when no other source (see HTML mail and MIME attachments) provides a MIME handler.
x-mailx-ignore
- An extension that enforces that this handler is not used at all.
The standard includes the possibility to define any number of
additional fields, prefixed by ‘x-
’.
Flag fields apply to the entire “Mailcap” entry — in
some unusual cases, this may not be desirable, but differentiation can be
accomplished via separate entries, taking advantage of the fact that
subsequent entries are searched if an earlier one does not provide enough
information. For example, if a view
command needs to
specify the needsterminal
flag, but the
compose
command shall not, the following will help
out the latter:
application/postscript; ps-to-terminal %s; needsterminal application/postscript; ps-to-terminal %s; compose=idraw %s
In value parts of command fields any occurrence of the format
string ‘%t
’ will be replaced by the
‘TYPE/SUBTYPE
’ specification. Any
named parameter from a messages'
‘Content-type:
’ field may be embedded
into the command line using the format
‘%{
’ followed by the parameter name
and a closing brace ‘}
’ character. The
entire parameter should appear as a single command line argument, regardless
of embedded spaces, shell quoting will be performed by the RFC 1524
processor, thus:
# Message Content-type: multipart/mixed; boundary=42 # Mailcap file multipart/*; /usr/local/bin/showmulti \ %t %{boundary} ; composetyped = /usr/local/bin/makemulti # Executed shell command /usr/local/bin/showmulti multipart/mixed 42
Note that Mail does not support handlers for multipart MIME parts
as shown in this example (as of today). It does not support the additional
formats ‘%n
’ and
‘%F
’. An example file, also showing
how to properly deal with the expansion of
‘%s
’, which includes any quotes that
are necessary to make it a valid shell argument by itself and thus will
cause undesired behaviour when placed in additional user-provided
quotes:
# Comment line text/richtext; richtext %s; copiousoutput text/x-perl; perl -cWT %s; nametemplate = %s.pl # Exit EX_TEMPFAIL=75 on signal application/pdf; \ infile=%s\; \ trap "rm -f ${infile}" EXIT\; \ trap "exit 75" INT QUIT TERM\; \ mupdf "${infile}"; \ test = [ -n "${DISPLAY}" ]; \ nametemplate = %s.pdf; x-mailx-async application/pdf; pdftotext -layout - -; copiousoutput application/*; echo "This is \\"%t\\" but \ is 50 \% Greek to me" \; < %s head -c 512 | cat -vet; \ copiousoutput; x-mailx-noquote; x-mailx-last-resort
Further reading:
HTML mail and MIME
attachments, The mime.types
files, mimetype
,
MAILCAPS
,
mime-counter-evidence,
pipe-TYPE/SUBTYPE,
pipe-EXTENSION.
The .netrc file
User credentials for machine accounts (see
On URL syntax and
credential lookup) can be placed in the .netrc
file, which will be loaded and cached when requested by
netrc-lookup. The default location
~/.netrc may be overridden by the
NETRC
environment variable. As long as syntax
constraints are honoured the file source may be replaced with the output of
the shell command set in netrc-pipe, to load an
encrypted file, for example. The cache can be managed with the command
netrc
.
The file consists of space, tabulator or newline separated tokens. This parser implements a superset of the original BSD syntax, but users should nonetheless be aware of portability glitches, shall their .netrc be usable across multiple programs and platforms:
- BSD only supports double quotation marks, for example
‘
password "pass with spaces"
’. - BSD (only?) supports escaping of single characters via a reverse solidus
(a space could be escaped via
‘
\
’), in- as well as outside of a quoted string. This method is assumed to be present, and will actively be used to quote double quotation marks ‘"
’ and reverse solidus ‘\
’ characters inside thelogin
andpassword
tokens, for example for display purposes. - BSD does not require a final quotation mark of the last user input token.
- The original BSD (Berknet) parser also supported a format which allowed tokens to be separated with commas – whereas at least Hewlett-Packard still seems to support this syntax, this parser does not!
- As a non-portable extension some widely-used programs support shell-style
comments: if an input line starts, after any amount of whitespace, with a
number sign ‘
#
’, then the rest of the line is ignored. - Whereas other programs may require that the .netrc
file is accessible by only the user if it contains a
password
token for any otherlogin
than “anonymous”, this parser will always require these strict permissions.
Of the following list of supported tokens this parser uses (and
caches) machine
, login
and
password
. An existing
default
entry will not be used.
machine
name- The hostname of the entries' machine, lowercase-normalized before use. Any
further file content, until either end-of-file or the occurrence of
another
machine
or adefault
first-class token is bound (only related) to the machine name.As an extension that should not be the cause of any worries this parser supports a single wildcard prefix for name:
machine *.example.com login USER password PASS machine pop3.example.com login USER password PASS machine smtp.example.com login USER password PASS
which would match ‘
xy.example.com
’ as well as ‘pop3.example.com
’, but neither ‘example.com
’ nor ‘local.smtp.example.com
’. In the example neither ‘pop3.example.com
’ nor ‘smtp.example.com
’ will be matched by the wildcard, since the exact matches take precedence (it is however faster to specify it the other way around). default
- This is the same as
machine
except that it is a fallback entry that is used shall none of the specified machines match; only one default token may be specified, and it must be the last first-class token. login
name- The user name on the remote machine.
password
string- The user's password on the remote machine.
account
string- Supply an additional account password. This is merely for FTP purposes.
macdef
name- Define a macro. A macro is defined with the specified
name; it is formed from all lines beginning with the
next line and continuing until a blank line is (consecutive newline
characters are) encountered. (Note that
macdef
entries cannot be utilized by multiple machines, too, but must be defined following themachine
they are intended to be used with.) If a macro named init exists, it is automatically run as the last step of the login process. This is merely for FTP purposes.
EXAMPLES
An example configuration
# This example assumes v15.0 compatibility mode set v15-compat # Request strict TLL transport layer security checks set tls-verify=strict # Where are the up-to-date TLS certificates? # (Since we manage up-to-date ones explicitly, do not use any, # possibly outdated, default certificates shipped with OpenSSL) #set tls-ca-dir=/etc/ssl/certs set tls-ca-file=/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt set tls-ca-no-defaults #set tls-ca-flags=partial-chain wysh set smime-ca-file="${tls-ca-file}" \ smime-ca-no-defaults #smime-ca-flags="${tls-ca-flags}" # This could be outsourced to a central configuration file via # tls-config-file plus tls-config-module if the used library allows. # CipherString: explicitly define the list of ciphers, which may # improve security, especially with protocols older than TLS v1.2. # See ciphers(1). Possibly best to only use tls-config-pairs-HOST # (or -USER@HOST), as necessary, again.. # Note that TLSv1.3 uses Ciphersuites= instead, which will join # with CipherString (if protocols older than v1.3 are allowed) # Curves: especially with TLSv1.3 curves selection may be desired. # MinProtocol,MaxProtocol: do not use protocols older than TLS v1.2. # Change this only when the remote server does not support it: # maybe use chain support via tls-config-pairs-HOST / -USER@HOST # to define such explicit exceptions, then, e.g., # MinProtocol=TLSv1.1 if "$tls-features" =% ,+ctx-set-maxmin-proto, wysh set tls-config-pairs='\ CipherString=TLSv1.2:!aNULL:!eNULL:@STRENGTH,\ Curves=P-521:P-384:P-256,\ MinProtocol=TLSv1.1' else wysh set tls-config-pairs='\ CipherString=TLSv1.2:!aNULL:!eNULL:@STRENGTH,\ Curves=P-521:P-384:P-256,\ Protocol=-ALL\,+TLSv1.1 \, +TLSv1.2\, +TLSv1.3' endif # Essential setting: select allowed character sets set sendcharsets=utf-8,iso-8859-1 # A very kind option: when replying to a message, first try to # use the same encoding that the original poster used herself! set reply-in-same-charset # When replying, do not merge From: and To: of the original message # into To:. Instead old From: -> new To:, old To: -> merge Cc:. set recipients-in-cc # When sending messages, wait until the Mail-Transfer-Agent finishs. # Only like this you will be able to see errors reported through the # exit status of the MTA (including the built-in SMTP one)! set sendwait # Only use built-in MIME types, no mime.types(5) files set mimetypes-load-control # Default directory where we act in (relative to $HOME) set folder=mail # A leading "+" (often) means: under *folder* # *record* is used to save copies of sent messages set MBOX=+mbox.mbox DEAD=+dead.txt \ record=+sent.mbox record-files record-resent # Make "file mymbox" and "file myrec" go to.. shortcut mymbox %:+mbox.mbox myrec +sent.mbox # Not really optional, e.g., for S/MIME set from='Your Name <address@exam.ple>' # It may be necessary to set hostname and/or smtp-hostname # if the "SERVER" of mta and "domain" of from do not match. # The `urlencode' command can be used to encode USER and PASS set mta=(smtps?|submissions?)://[USER[:PASS]@]SERVER[:PORT] \ smtp-auth=login/plain... \ smtp-use-starttls # Never refuse to start into interactive mode, and more set emptystart \ colour-pager crt= \ followup-to followup-to-honour=ask-yes fullnames \ history-file=+.mailhist history-size=-1 history-gabby \ mime-counter-evidence=0b1111 \ prompt='?\$?!\$!/\$^ERRNAME[\$account#\$mailbox-display]? ' \ reply-to-honour=ask-yes \ umask= # Only include the selected header fields when typing messages headerpick type retain from_ date from to cc subject \ message-id mail-followup-to reply-to # ...when forwarding messages headerpick forward retain subject date from to cc # ...when saving message, etc. #headerpick save ignore ^Original-.*$ ^X-.*$ # Some mailing lists mlist '@xyz-editor\.xyz$' '@xyzf\.xyz$' mlsubscribe '^xfans@xfans\.xyz$' # Handle a few file extensions (to store MBOX databases) filetype bz2 'bzip2 -dc' 'bzip2 -zc' \ gz 'gzip -dc' 'gzip -c' xz 'xz -dc' 'xz -zc' \ zst 'zstd -dc' 'zstd -19 -zc' \ zst.pgp 'gpg -d | zstd -dc' 'zstd -19 -zc | gpg -e' # A real life example of a very huge free mail provider # Instead of directly placing content inside `account', # we `define' a macro: like that we can switch "accounts" # from within *on-compose-splice*, for example! define XooglX { set folder=~/spool/XooglX inbox=+syste.mbox sent=+sent set from='Your Name <address@examp.ple>' set pop3-no-apop-pop.gmXil.com shortcut pop %:pop3s://pop.gmXil.com shortcut imap %:imaps://imap.gmXil.com # Or, entirely IMAP based setup #set folder=imaps://imap.gmail.com record="+[Gmail]/Sent Mail" \ # imap-cache=~/spool/cache set mta=smtp://USER:PASS@smtp.gmXil.com smtp-use-starttls # Alternatively: set mta=smtps://USER:PASS@smtp.gmail.com:465 } account XooglX { \call XooglX } # Here is a pretty large one which does not allow sending mails # if there is a domain name mismatch on the SMTP protocol level, # which would bite us if the value of from does not match, e.g., # for people who have a sXXXXeforge project and want to speak # with the mailing list under their project account (in from), # still sending the message through their normal mail provider define XandeX { set folder=~/spool/XandeX inbox=+syste.mbox sent=+sent set from='Your Name <address@exam.ple>' shortcut pop %:pop3s://pop.yaXXex.com shortcut imap %:imaps://imap.yaXXex.com set mta=smtps://USER:PASS@smtp.yaXXex.com:465 \ hostname=yaXXex.com smtp-hostname= } account XandeX { \call Xandex } # Create some new commands so that, e.g., `ls /tmp' will.. commandalias lls '!ls ${LS_COLOUR_FLAG} -aFlrS' commandalias llS '!ls ${LS_COLOUR_FLAG} -aFlS' set pipe-message/external-body='?* echo $MAILX_EXTERNAL_BODY_URL' # We do not support gpg(1) directly yet. But simple --clearsign'd # message parts can be dealt with as follows: define V { localopts yes wysh set pipe-text/plain=$'?*#++=?\ < "${MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY}" awk \ -v TMPFILE="${MAILX_FILENAME_TEMPORARY}" \'\ BEGIN{done=0}\ /^-----BEGIN PGP SIGNED MESSAGE-----/,/^$/ {\ if(done++ != 0)\ next;\ print "--- GPG --verify ---";\ system("gpg --verify " TMPFILE " 2>&1");\ print "--- GPG --verify ---";\ print "";\ next;\ }\ /^-----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----/,\ /^-----END PGP SIGNATURE-----/{\ next;\ }\ {print}\ \'' print } commandalias V '\'call V
When storing passwords in ~/.mailrc
appropriate permissions should be set on this file with
‘$ chmod 0600 ~/.mailrc
’. If the
[Option]al netrc-lookup is available user credentials
can be stored in the central ~/.netrc file instead;
e.g., here is a different version of the example account that sets up SMTP
and POP3:
define XandeX { set folder=~/spool/XandeX inbox=+syste.mbox sent=+sent set from='Your Name <address@exam.ple>' set netrc-lookup # Load an encrypted ~/.netrc by uncommenting the next line #set netrc-pipe='gpg -qd ~/.netrc.pgp' set mta=smtps://smtp.yXXXXx.ru:465 \ smtp-hostname= hostname=yXXXXx.com set pop3-keepalive=240 pop3-no-apop-pop.yXXXXx.ru commandalias xp fi pop3s://pop.yXXXXx.ru } account XandeX { \call XandeX }
and, in the ~/.netrc file:
machine *.yXXXXx.ru login USER password PASS
This configuration should now work just fine:
$ echo text | mail -dvv -AXandeX -s
Subject user@exam.ple
S/MIME step by step
[Option] The first thing that is needed for
Signed and
encrypted messages with S/MIME is a personal certificate, and a private
key. The certificate contains public information, in particular a name and
email address(es), and the public key that can be used by others to encrypt
messages for the certificate holder (the owner of the private key), and to
verify
signed messages generated with that
certificate('s private key). Whereas the certificate is included in each
signed message, the private key must be kept secret. It is used to decrypt
messages that were previously encrypted with the public key, and to sign
messages.
For personal use it is recommended to get a S/MIME certificate from one of the major CAs on the Internet. Many CAs offer such certificates for free. Usually offered is a combined certificate and private key in PKCS#12 format which Mail does not accept directly. To convert it to PEM format, the following shell command can be used; please read on for how to use these PEM files.
$ openssl pkcs12 -in cert.p12 -out certpem.pem -clcerts -nodes $ # Alternatively $ openssl pkcs12 -in cert.p12 -out cert.pem -clcerts -nokeys $ openssl pkcs12 -in cert.p12 -out key.pem -nocerts -nodes
There is also https://www.CAcert.org which issues client and server certificates to members of their community for free; their root certificate (https://www.cacert.org/certs/root.crt) is often not in the default set of trusted CA root certificates, though, which means their root certificate has to be downloaded separately, and needs to be part of the S/MIME certificate validation chain by including it in smime-ca-dir or as a vivid member of the smime-ca-file. But let us take a step-by-step tour on how to setup S/MIME with a certificate from CAcert.org despite this situation!
First of all you will have to become a member of the CAcert.org community, simply by registrating yourself via the web interface. Once you are, create and verify all email addresses you want to be able to create signed and encrypted messages for/with using the corresponding entries of the web interface. Now ready to create S/MIME certificates, so let us create a new “client certificate”, ensure to include all email addresses that should be covered by the certificate in the following web form, and also to use your name as the “common name”.
Create a private key and a certificate request on your local computer (please see the manual pages of the used commands for more in-depth knowledge on what the used arguments etc. do):
$ openssl req -nodes -newkey rsa:4096
-keyout key.pem -out creq.pem
Afterwards copy-and-paste the content of “creq.pem” into the certificate-request (CSR) field of the web form on the CAcert.org website (you may need to unfold some “advanced options” to see the corresponding text field). This last step will ensure that your private key (which never left your box) and the certificate belong together (through the public key that will find its way into the certificate via the certificate-request). You are now ready and can create your CAcert certified certificate. Download and store or copy-and-paste it as “pub.crt”.
Yay. In order to use your new S/MIME setup a combined private key/public key (certificate) file has to be created:
$ cat key.pem pub.crt >
ME@HERE.com.paired
This is the file Mail will work with. If you have created your private key with a passphrase then Mail will ask you for it whenever a message is signed or decrypted, unless this operation has been automated as described in Signed and encrypted messages with S/MIME. Set the following variables to henceforth use S/MIME (setting smime-ca-file is of interest for verification only):
? set smime-ca-file=ALL-TRUSTED-ROOT-CERTS-HERE \ smime-sign-cert=ME@HERE.com.paired \ smime-sign-digest=SHA512 \ smime-sign from=myname@my.host
Using CRLs with S/MIME or TLS
[Option] Certification authorities (CAs) issue certificate revocation lists (CRLs) on a regular basis. These lists contain the serial numbers of certificates that have been declared invalid after they have been issued. Such usually happens because the private key for the certificate has been compromised, because the owner of the certificate has left the organization that is mentioned in the certificate, etc. To seriously use S/MIME or TLS verification, an up-to-date CRL is required for each trusted CA. There is otherwise no method to distinguish between valid and invalidated certificates. Mail currently offers no mechanism to fetch CRLs, nor to access them on the Internet, so they have to be retrieved by some external mechanism.
Mail accepts CRLs in PEM format only; CRLs in DER format must be converted, like, e.g.:
$ openssl crl -inform DER -in crl.der
-out crl.pem
To tell Mail about the CRLs, a directory that contains all CRL files (and no other files) must be created. The smime-crl-dir or tls-crl-dir variables, respectively, must then be set to point to that directory. After that, Mail requires a CRL to be present for each CA that is used to verify a certificate.
FAQ
In general it is a good idea to turn on
debug (-d
) and / or
verbose (-v
, twice) if
something does not work well. Very often a diagnostic message can be
produced that leads to the problems' solution.
Mail shortly hangs on startup
This can have two reasons, one is the necessity to wait for a file
lock and cannot be helped, the other being that Mail calls the function
uname(2) in order to query the
nodename of the box (sometimes the real one is needed instead of the one
represented by the internal variable hostname). One
may have varying success by ensuring that the real hostname and
‘localhost
’ have entries in
/etc/hosts, or, more generally, that the name
service is properly setup – and does
hostname(1) return the expected
value? Does this local hostname have a domain suffix? RFC 6762 standardized
the link-local top-level domain
‘.local
’, try again after adding an
(additional) entry with this extension.
I cannot login to Google mail (via OAuth)
Since 2014 some free service providers classify programs as “less secure” unless they use a special authentication method (OAuth 2.0) which was not standardized for non-HTTP protocol authentication token query until August 2015 (RFC 7628).
Different to Kerberos / GSSAPI, which is developed since the mid of the 1980s, where a user can easily create a local authentication ticket for her- and himself with the locally installed kinit(1) program, that protocol has no such local part but instead requires a world-wide-web query to create or fetch a token; since there is no local cache this query would have to be performed whenever Mail is invoked (in interactive sessions situation may differ).
Mail does not directly support OAuth. It, however, supports XOAUTH2 / OAUTHBEARER, see But, how about XOAUTH2 / OAUTHBEARER? If that is not used it is necessary to declare Mail a “less secure app” (on the providers account web page) in order to read and send mail. However, it also seems possible to take the following steps instead:
- give the provider the number of a mobile phone,
- enable “2-Step Verification”,
- create an application specific password (16 characters), and
- use that special password instead of the real Google account password in Mail (for more on that see the section On URL syntax and credential lookup).
But, how about XOAUTH2 / OAUTHBEARER?
Following up I cannot login to Google mail (via OAuth) one OAuth-based authentication method is available: the OAuth 2.0 bearer token usage as standardized in RFC 6750 (according SASL mechanism in RFC 7628), also known as XOAUTH2 and OAUTHBEARER, allows fetching a temporary access token via the web that can locally be used as a password. The protocol is simple and extendable, token updates or even password changes via a simple TLS secured server login would be possible in theory, but today a web browser and an external support tool are prerequisites for using this authentication method. The token times out and must be periodically refreshed via the web.
Some hurdles must be taken before being able to use this method. Using GMail as an example, an application (that is a name) must be registered, for which credentials, a “client ID” and a “client secret”, need to be created and saved locally (in a secure way). These initial configuration steps can be performed at https://console.developers.google.com/apis/credentials. Thereafter a refresh token can be requested; a python program to do this for GMail accounts is https://github.com/google/gmail-oauth2-tools/raw/master/python/oauth2.py:
$ python oauth2.py --user=EMAIL \ --client-id=THE-ID --client-secret=THE-SECRET \ --generate_oauth2_token To authorize token, visit this url and follow the directions: https://accounts.google.com/o/oauth2/auth?client_id=... Enter verification code: ... Refresh Token: ... Access Token: ... Access Token Expiration Seconds: 3600 $ # Of which the last three are actual token responses. $ # Thereafter access tokens can regularly be refreshed $ # via the created refresh token (read on)
The generated refresh token must also be saved locally (securely). The procedure as a whole can be read at https://github.com/google/gmail-oauth2-tools/wiki/OAuth2DotPyRunThrough. Since periodic timers are not yet supported, keeping an access token up-to-date (from within Mail) can only be performed via the hook on-main-loop-tick, or (for sending only) on-compose-enter (for more on authentication please see the section On URL syntax and credential lookup):
set on-main-loop-tick=o-m-l-t on-compose-enter=o-c-e define o-m-l-t { xcall update_access_token } define o-c-e { xcall update_access_token } set access_token_=0 define update_access_token { local set i epoch_sec epoch_nsec vput vexpr i epoch eval set $i # set epoch_sec/_nsec of vexpr epoch vput vexpr i + $access_token_ 2100 if $epoch_sec -ge $i vput ! password python oauth2.py --user=EMAIL \ --client-id=THE-ID --client-secret=THE-SECRET \ --refresh-token=THE-REFRESH-TOKEN |\ sed '1b PASS;d; :PASS s/^.\{1,\}:\(.\{1,\}\)$/\1/' vput csop password trim "$password" if -n "$verbose" echo password is <$password> endif set access_token_=$epoch_sec endif }
Not "defunctional", but the editor key does not work
Two thinkable situations: the first is a shadowed sequence;
setting debug, or the most possible
verbose mode, causes a printout of the
bind
tree after that is built; being a cache, this
happens only upon startup or after modifying bindings.
Or second, terminal libraries (see
On terminal
control and line editor, bind
,
termcap) may report different codes than the terminal
really sends, rendering bindings dysfunctional because expected and received
data do not match; the verbose listing of
bind
ings will show the byte sequences that are
expected. (One common source of problems is that the — possibly even
non-existing — keypad is not turned on, and the resulting layout
reports the keypad control codes for the normal keyboard keys.)
To overcome the situation use for example the program
cat(1) with its option
-v
, if available, to see the byte sequences which
are actually produced by keypresses, and use the variable
termcap to make Mail aware of them. The terminal this
is typed on produces some unexpected sequences, here for an example the
shifted home key:
? set verbose ? bind* # 1B 5B=[ 31=1 3B=; 32=2 48=H bind base :kHOM z0 ? x $ cat -v ^[[H $ mail -v -Stermcap='kHOM=\E[H' ? bind* # 1B 5B=[ 48=H bind base :kHOM z0
Can Mail git-send-email?
Yes. Put (at least parts of) the following in your ~/.gitconfig:
[sendemail] smtpserver = /usr/bin/mail smtpserveroption = -t #smtpserveroption = -Sexpandaddr smtpserveroption = -Athe-account-you-need ## suppresscc = all suppressfrom = false assume8bitEncoding = UTF-8 #to = /tmp/OUT confirm = always chainreplyto = true multiedit = false thread = true quiet = true annotate = true
Newer git(1) versions
(v2.33.0) added the option sendmailCmd
. Patches can
also be send directly, for example:
$ git format-patch -M --stdout HEAD^ | mail -A the-account-you-need -t RECEIVER
Howto handle stale dotlock files
folder
sometimes fails to open MBOX mail
databases because creation of dotlock
files is impossible due to existing but unowned lock files. Mail does
not offer an option to deal with those files, because it is considered a
site policy what counts as unowned, and what not. The site policy is usually
defined by administrator(s), and expressed in the configuration of a locally
installed MTA (for example Postfix
‘stale_lock_time=500s
’). Therefore the
suggestion:
$ </dev/null mail -s 'MTA: be no frog, handle lock' $LOGNAME
By sending a mail to yourself the local MTA can use its normal queue mechanism to try the delivery multiple times, finally decide a lock file has become stale, and remove it.
IMAP CLIENT
[Option]ally there is IMAP client support available. This part of
the program is obsolete and will vanish in v15 with the large MIME and I/O
layer rewrite, because it uses old-style blocking I/O and makes excessive
use of signal based long code jumps. Support can hopefully be readded later
based on a new-style I/O, with SysV signal handling. In fact the IMAP
support had already been removed from the codebase, but was reinstantiated
on user demand: in effect the IMAP code is at the level of Mail v14.8.16
(with imapcodec
being the sole exception), and
should be treated with some care.
IMAP uses the ‘imap://
’ and
‘imaps://
’ protocol prefixes, and an
IMAP-based folder may be used. IMAP URLs (paths)
undergo inspections and possible transformations before use (and the command
imapcodec
can be used to manually apply them to any
given argument). Hierarchy delimiters are normalized, a step which is
configurable via the imap-delim variable chain, but
defaults to the first seen delimiter otherwise. Mail supports
internationalised IMAP names, and en- and decodes the names from and to the
ttycharset as necessary and possible. If a mailbox
name is expanded (see
Filename transformations)
to an IMAP mailbox, all names that begin with `+' then refer to IMAP
mailboxes below the folder target box, while folder
names prefixed by `@' refer to folders below the hierarchy base, so the
following will list all folders below the current one when in an IMAP
mailbox: ‘folders @
’.
Note: some IMAP servers do not accept the creation of mailboxes in the hierarchy base, but require that they are created as subfolders of `INBOX' – with such servers a folder name of the form
imaps://mylogin@imap.myisp.example/INBOX.
should be used (the last character is the server's hierarchy delimiter). The following IMAP-specific commands exist:
cache
- Only applicable to cached IMAP mailboxes; takes a message list and reads the specified messages into the IMAP cache.
connect
- If operating in disconnected mode on an IMAP mailbox, switch to online mode and connect to the mail server while retaining the mailbox status. See the description of the disconnected variable for more information.
disconnect
- If operating in online mode on an IMAP mailbox, switch to disconnected
mode while retaining the mailbox status. See the description of the
disconnected variable for more. A list of messages
may optionally be given as argument; the respective messages are then read
into the cache before the connection is closed, thus
‘
disco *
’ makes the entire mailbox available for disconnected use. imap
- Sends command strings directly to the current IMAP server. Mail operates
always in IMAP `selected state' on the current mailbox; commands that
change this will produce undesirable results and should be avoided. Useful
IMAP commands are:
- create
- Takes the name of an IMAP mailbox as an argument and creates it.
- getquotaroot
- (RFC 2087) Takes the name of an IMAP mailbox as an argument and prints the quotas that apply to the mailbox. Not all IMAP servers support this command.
- namespace
- (RFC 2342) Takes no arguments and prints the Personal Namespaces, the Other User's Namespaces and the Shared Namespaces. Each namespace type is printed in parentheses; if there are multiple namespaces of the same type, inner parentheses separate them. For each namespace a prefix and a hierarchy separator is listed. Not all IMAP servers support this command.
imapcodec
- Perform IMAP path transformations. Supports
vput
(see Command modifiers), and manages the error number !. The first argument specifies the operation: e[ncode] normalizes hierarchy delimiters (see imap-delim) and converts the strings from the locale ttycharset to the internationalized variant used by IMAP, d[ecode] performs the reverse operation. Encoding will honour the (global) value of imap-delim.
The following IMAP-specific internal variables exist:
- disconnected
- (Boolean) When an IMAP mailbox is selected and this variable is set, no
connection to the server is initiated. Instead, data is obtained from the
local cache (see imap-cache). Mailboxes that are not
present in the cache and messages that have not yet entirely been fetched
from the server are not available; to fetch all messages in a mailbox at
once, the command `
copy * /dev/null
' can be used while still in connected mode. Changes that are made to IMAP mailboxes in disconnected mode are queued and committed later when a connection to that server is made. This procedure is not completely reliable since it cannot be guaranteed that the IMAP unique identifiers (UIDs) on the server still match the ones in the cache at that time. Data is saved toDEAD
when this problem occurs. - disconnected-USER@HOST
- The specified account is handled as described for the disconnected variable above, but other accounts are not affected.
- imap-auth-USER@HOST, imap-auth
- Sets the IMAP authentication method. Supported are the default
‘
login
’ (called ‘plain
’ by some servers), [v15-compat] ‘oauthbearer
’ (see FAQ entry But, how about XOAUTH2 / OAUTHBEARER?), [v15-compat] ‘external
’ and ‘externanon
’ (for TLS secured connections which pass a client certificate via tls-config-pairs), as well as the [Option]al ‘cram-md5
’ and ‘gssapi
’. All methods need a user and a password except ‘gssapi
’ and ‘external
’, which only need the former. ‘externanon
’ solely builds upon the credentials passed via a client certificate, and is usually the way to go since tested servers do not actually follow RFC 4422, and fail if additional credentials are actually passed. - imap-cache
- Enables caching of IMAP mailboxes. The value of this variable must point to a directory that is either existent or can be created by Mail. All contents of the cache can be deleted by Mail at any time; it is not safe to make assumptions about them.
- imap-delim-USER@HOST, imap-delim-HOST, imap-delim
- The hierarchy separator used by the IMAP server. Whenever an IMAP path is
specified it will undergo normalization. One of the normalization steps is
the squeezing and adjustment of hierarchy separators. If this variable is
set, any occurrence of any character of the given value that exists in the
path will be replaced by the first member of the value; an empty value
will cause the default to be used, it is
‘
/.
’. If not set, we will reuse the first hierarchy separator character that is discovered in a user-given mailbox name. - imap-keepalive-USER@HOST, imap-keepalive-HOST, imap-keepalive
- IMAP servers may close the connection after a period of inactivity; the standard requires this to be at least 30 minutes, but practical experience may vary. Setting this variable to a numeric `value' greater than 0 causes a `NOOP' command to be sent each `value' seconds if no other operation is performed.
- imap-list-depth
- When retrieving the list of folders on an IMAP server, the
folders
command stops after it has reached a certain depth to avoid possible infinite loops. The value of this variable sets the maximum depth allowed. The default is 2. If the folder separator on the current IMAP server is a slash `/', this variable has no effect and thefolders
command does not descend to subfolders. - imap-use-starttls-USER@HOST, imap-use-starttls-HOST, imap-use-starttls
- Causes Mail to issue a `STARTTLS' command to make an unencrypted IMAP session TLS encrypted. This functionality is not supported by all servers, and is not used if the session is already encrypted by the IMAPS method.
SEE ALSO
bogofilter(1), gpg(1), more(1), newaliases(1), openssl(1), sendmail(1), sh(1), spamassassin(1), iconv(3), setlocale(3), aliases(5), termcap(5), terminfo(5), locale(7), mailaddr(7), re_format(7) (or regex(7)), mailwrapper(8), sendmail(8)
HISTORY
M. Douglas McIlroy writes in his article “A Research UNIX Reader: Annotated Excerpts from the Programmer's Manual, 1971-1986” that a mail(1) command already appeared in First Edition UNIX in 1971:
BSD Mail, in large parts compatible with UNIX mail, was written in 1978 by Kurt Shoens and developed as part of the BSD UNIX distribution until 1995. This manual page is derived from “The Mail Reference Manual” that Kurt Shoens wrote for Mail 1.3, included in 3BSD in 1980. The common UNIX and BSD denominator became standardized as mailx(1) in the X/Open Portability Guide Issue 2 (January 1987). After the rise of Open Source BSD variants Mail saw continuous development in the individual code forks, noticeably by Christos Zoulas in NetBSD. Based upon this Nail, later Heirloom Mailx, was developed by Gunnar Ritter in the years 2000 until 2008. Since 2012 S-nail is maintained by Steffen Nurpmeso.
Electronic mail exchange in general is a concept even older. The earliest well documented electronic mail system was part of the Compatible Time Sharing System (CTSS) at MIT, its MAIL command had been proposed in a staff planning memo at the end of 1964 and was implemented in mid-1965 when Tom Van Vleck and Noel Morris wrote the necessary code. Similar communication programs were built for other timesharing systems. One of the most ambitious and influential was Murray Turoff's EMISARI. Created in 1971 for the United States Office of Emergency Preparedness, EMISARI combined private electronic messages with a chat system, public postings, voting, and a user directory.
During the 1960s it was common to connect a large number of
terminals to a single, central computer. Connecting two computers together
was relatively unusual. This began to change with the development of the
ARPANET, the ancestor of today's Internet. In 1971 Ray Tomlinson adapted the
SNDMSG program, originally developed for the University of California at
Berkeley timesharing system, to give it the ability to transmit a message
across the network into the mailbox of a user on a different computer. For
the first time it was necessary to specify the recipient's computer as well
as an account name. Tomlinson decided that the underused commercial at
‘@
’ would work to separate the
two.
Sending a message across the network was originally treated as a special instance of transmitting a file, and so a MAIL command was included in RFC 385 on file transfer in 1972. Because it was not always clear when or where a message had come from, RFC 561 in 1973 aimed to formalize electronic mail headers, including “from”, “date”, and “subject”. In 1975 RFC 680 described fields to help with the transmission of messages to multiple users, including “to”, “cc”, and “bcc”. In 1977 these features and others went from best practices to a binding standard in RFC 733. Queen Elizabeth II of England became the first head of state to send electronic mail on March 26 1976 while ceremonially opening a building in the British Royal Signals and Radar Establishment (RSRE) in Malvern.
AUTHORS
Kurt Shoens, Edward Wang, Keith Bostic, Christos Zoulas, Gunnar Ritter. Mail is developed by Steffen Nurpmeso ⟨s-mailx@lists.sdaoden.eu⟩.
CAVEATS
[v15 behaviour may differ] Interrupting an operation via
SIGINT
aka
‘control-C
’ from anywhere else but a
command prompt is very problematic and likely to leave the program in an
undefined state: many library functions cannot deal with the
siglongjmp
(3) that this
software (still) performs; even though efforts have been taken to address
this, no sooner but in v15 it will have been worked out: interruptions have
not been disabled in order to allow forceful breakage of hanging network
connections, for example (all this is unrelated to
ignore).
The SMTP and POP3 protocol support of Mail is very basic. Also, if it fails to contact its upstream SMTP server, it will not make further attempts to transfer the message at a later time (setting save and sendwait may be useful). If this is a concern, it might be better to set up a local SMTP server that is capable of message queuing.
BUGS
When a network-based mailbox is open, directly changing to another network-based mailbox of a different protocol (i.e., from POP3 to IMAP or vice versa) will cause a “deadlock”.
After deleting some message of a POP3 mailbox the header summary falsely claims that there are no messages to display, one needs to perform a scroll or dot movement to restore proper state.
In ‘thread
’ed
sort
mode a power user may encounter crashes very
occasionally (this is may and very).
Please report bugs to the contact-mail
address, for example from within mail: ‘?
’. Including the verbose
output of the command eval
mail
$contact-mailversion
may be helpful:
? wysh set escape=! verbose; vput version xy; unset verbose;\ eval mail $contact-mail Bug subject !I xy !.
Information on the web at ‘$ mail -X 'echo
$contact-web; x'
’.
March 26, 2022 | Linux 6.10.10-arch1-1 |